blob: 50985eb399f0d40cf0178178bc3b0a96dec7f062 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau6b07bf72013-12-17 00:45:49 +01007 2013/12/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
727.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
737.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
757.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
767.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
777.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078
798. Logging
808.1. Log levels
818.2. Log formats
828.2.1. Default log format
838.2.2. TCP log format
848.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100858.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100868.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200878.3. Advanced logging options
888.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
898.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
908.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
918.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
928.4. Timing events
938.5. Session state at disconnection
948.6. Non-printable characters
958.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
968.8. Capturing HTTP headers
978.9. Examples of logs
98
999. Statistics and monitoring
1009.1. CSV format
1019.2. Unix Socket commands
102
103
1041. Quick reminder about HTTP
105----------------------------
106
107When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
108fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
109on almost anything found in the contents.
110
111However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
112formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
113correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
114
115
1161.1. The HTTP transaction model
117-------------------------------
118
119The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100120to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
122connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
123will involve a new connection :
124
125 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
126
127In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
128establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
129by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
130length.
131
132Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
133to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
134however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
135response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
136header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
137
138 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
139
140Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
141power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
142but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200143a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144
145A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
146keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
147second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
148page :
149
150 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
151
152This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
153latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
154correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
155the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100156server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
159connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
160everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
161established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
162sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
163while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
164another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
165sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
166http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
167mode.
168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
1701.2. HTTP request
171-----------------
172
173First, let's consider this HTTP request :
174
175 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100176 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
178 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
179 3 User-agent: my small browser
180 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
181 5 Accept: image/png
182
183
1841.2.1. The Request line
185-----------------------
186
187Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
188
189 - a METHOD : GET
190 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
191 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
192
193All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
194which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
195followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
196is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
197desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
198the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
199
200The URI itself can have several forms :
201
202 - A "relative URI" :
203
204 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
205
206 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
207 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
208
209 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
210
211 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
212
213 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
214 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
215 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
216 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
217 must accept this form too.
218
219 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
220 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
221 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200223 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
224 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
225 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
226 other protocols too.
227
228In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
229mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
230on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
231It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
232specific to the language, framework or application in use.
233
234
2351.2.2. The request headers
236--------------------------
237
238The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
239beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
240an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
241Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
242values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
243encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
244the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
245define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
246
247Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
248their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
249"Connection:" header).
250
251The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
252that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
253is one valid form of empty line.
254
255Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
256headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
257about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
258application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
259
260Important note:
261 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
262 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
263 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
264 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
265
266
2671.3. HTTP response
268------------------
269
270An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
271messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
272
273 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100274 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200275 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
276 2 Content-length: 350
277 3 Content-Type: text/html
278
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200279As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
280codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
281response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100282continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
283the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
284following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
285sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
286(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
287correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
288such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
289state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
290over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
291if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
292information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
2951.3.1. The Response line
296------------------------
297
298Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
299
300 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
301 - a status code : 200
302 - a reason : OK
303
304The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200305 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
307 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
308 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
309 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
310
311Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
314messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
315or "Authentication Required".
316
317Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
318
319 Code When / reason
320 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
321 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
322 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
323 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100324 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326 400 for an invalid or too large request
327 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
328 accessing the stats page)
329 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
330 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
331 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
332 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
333 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
334 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
335 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
336 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
337 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
338
339The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3404.2).
341
342
3431.3.2. The response headers
344---------------------------
345
346Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
347the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
348details.
349
350
3512. Configuring HAProxy
352----------------------
353
3542.1. Configuration file format
355------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200356
357HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
358
359 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
360 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
361 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
362 "frontend" and "backend".
363
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
365referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
366delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100367preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100368escaped by doubling them.
369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370
3712.2. Time format
372----------------
373
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100374Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100375values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
376otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
377numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
378for every keyword. Supported units are :
379
380 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
381 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
382 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
383 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
384 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
385 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
386
387
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003882.3. Examples
389-------------
390
391 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
392 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
393 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
394 global
395 daemon
396 maxconn 256
397
398 defaults
399 mode http
400 timeout connect 5000ms
401 timeout client 50000ms
402 timeout server 50000ms
403
404 frontend http-in
405 bind *:80
406 default_backend servers
407
408 backend servers
409 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
410
411
412 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
413 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
414 global
415 daemon
416 maxconn 256
417
418 defaults
419 mode http
420 timeout connect 5000ms
421 timeout client 50000ms
422 timeout server 50000ms
423
424 listen http-in
425 bind *:80
426 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
427
428
429Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
430
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100431 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432
433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004343. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200435--------------------
436
437Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
438are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
439of them have command-line equivalents.
440
441The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
442
443 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200444 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200445 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200446 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200447 - daemon
448 - gid
449 - group
450 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100451 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - nbproc
453 - pidfile
454 - uid
455 - ulimit-n
456 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200457 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200458 - node
459 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100460 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100461
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200462 * Performance tuning
463 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200464 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100465 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100466 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100467 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200468 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200469 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200470 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200471 - noepoll
472 - nokqueue
473 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100474 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200475 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200476 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200477 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100478 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100479 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200480 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100481 - tune.maxaccept
482 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200483 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200484 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100485 - tune.rcvbuf.client
486 - tune.rcvbuf.server
487 - tune.sndbuf.client
488 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100489 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100490 - tune.ssl.lifetime
491 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100492 - tune.zlib.memlevel
493 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100494
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200495 * Debugging
496 - debug
497 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200498
499
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005003.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200501------------------------------------
502
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200503ca-base <dir>
504 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200505 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
506 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200507
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200508chroot <jail dir>
509 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
510 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
511 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
512 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
513 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
514 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100515
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100516cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
517 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
518 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
519 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
520 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
521 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
522 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
523 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
524 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
525 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
526 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
527 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
528 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
529 they overlap.
530
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200531crt-base <dir>
532 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
533 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
534 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
535
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200536daemon
537 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
538 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
539 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
540
541gid <number>
542 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
543 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
544 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100545 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
546 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100548
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200549group <group name>
550 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
551 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100552
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200553log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200554 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
555 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100556 configured with "log global".
557
558 <address> can be one of:
559
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100560 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100561 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
562 port).
563
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100564 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
565 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
566 port).
567
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100568 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
569 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
570 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
571 writeable).
572
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100573 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
574 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
575 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
576 in Bourne shell.
577
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100578 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200579
580 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
581 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
582 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
583
584 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200585 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
586 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
587 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
588 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
589 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
590 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200592 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200593
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100594log-send-hostname [<string>]
595 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
596 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
597 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
598 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
599 the logs.
600
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000601log-tag <string>
602 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
603 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
604 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
605 running on the same host.
606
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607nbproc <number>
608 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
609 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
610 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
611 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
612 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
613
614pidfile <pidfile>
615 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
616 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
617 starting the process. See also "daemon".
618
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100619stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200620 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
621 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
622 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
623 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
624 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
625 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
626 the number of processes used.
627
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200628stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
629 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
630 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
631 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
632 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200633
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200634 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
635 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
636 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200637
638stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
639 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
640 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100641 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200642
643stats maxconn <connections>
644 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
645 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
646
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200647uid <number>
648 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
649 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
650 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
651 one. See also "gid" and "user".
652
653ulimit-n <number>
654 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
655 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
656 option.
657
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100658unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
659 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
660
661 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
662 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
663 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
664 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
665 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
666 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
667 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
668 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
669 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
670 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
671
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200672user <user name>
673 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
674 See also "uid" and "group".
675
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200676node <name>
677 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
678
679 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
680 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
681 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
682 traffic.
683
684description <text>
685 Add a text that describes the instance.
686
687 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
688 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
689 "<" and ">" characters.
690
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200691
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006923.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200693-----------------------
694
695maxconn <number>
696 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
697 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
698 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
699 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
700
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200701maxconnrate <number>
702 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
703 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
704 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
705 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
706 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
707 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
708 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
709 fairness.
710
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100711maxcomprate <number>
712 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
713 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
714 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
715 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
716 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
717 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
718 default value.
719
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100720maxcompcpuusage <number>
721 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
722 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
723 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
724 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
725 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
726 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
727 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
728 process down and from introducing high latencies.
729
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100730maxpipes <number>
731 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
732 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
733 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
734 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
735 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
736 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
737
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200738maxsessrate <number>
739 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
740 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
741 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
742 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
743 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
744 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
745 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
746 fairness.
747
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200748maxsslconn <number>
749 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
750 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
751 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
752 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
753 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
754 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
755 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
756
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200757maxsslrate <number>
758 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
759 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
760 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
761 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
762 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
763 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
764 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
765 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
766 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
767 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
768
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100769maxzlibmem <number>
770 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
771 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
772 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100773 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
774 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
775 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
776
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200777noepoll
778 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
779 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100780 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200781
782nokqueue
783 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
784 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
785 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
786
787nopoll
788 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
789 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100790 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100791 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200792
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100793nosplice
794 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
795 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
796 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100797 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100798 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
799 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
800 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
801 "option splice-response".
802
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200803spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900804 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
805 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
806 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
807 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
808 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
809 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200810
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200811tune.bufsize <number>
812 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
813 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
814 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
815 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
816 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
817 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
818 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
819 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400820 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
821 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
822 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200823
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200824tune.chksize <number>
825 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
826 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
827 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
828 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
829 checks whenever possible.
830
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100831tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
832 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
833 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
834 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
835 this value. The default value is 1.
836
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100837tune.http.cookielen <number>
838 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
839 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
840 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
841 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
842 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
843 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
844 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
845 to change this value.
846
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200847tune.http.maxhdr <number>
848 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
849 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
850 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
851 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
852 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
853 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
854 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
855 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
856 limit too high.
857
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100858tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100859 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
860 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
861 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
862 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
863 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
864 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
865 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
866 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
867 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
868 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100869
870tune.maxpollevents <number>
871 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
872 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
873 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
874 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
875 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
876
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200877tune.maxrewrite <number>
878 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
879 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
880 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
881 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
882 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
883 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
884 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
885 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
886 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
887 bufsize.
888
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200889tune.pipesize <number>
890 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
891 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
892 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
893 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
894 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
895 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
896
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100897tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
898tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
899 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
900 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
901 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
902 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
903 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
904 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
905 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
906
907tune.sndbuf.client <number>
908tune.sndbuf.server <number>
909 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
910 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
911 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
912 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
913 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
914 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
915 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
916 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
917 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
918 notifying haproxy again.
919
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100920tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100921 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
922 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
923 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
924 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block use approximatively
925 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
926 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
927 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
928 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
929 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100930 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
931 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100932
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100933tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
934 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
935 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 mn). It is important to understand that it
936 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
937 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
938 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
939 being used for too long.
940
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100941tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
942 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
943 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
944 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
945 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
946 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
947 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
948 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
949 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
950 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
951 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
952 best value.
953
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100954tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
955 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
956 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
957 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
958 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
959 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
960
961tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
962 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
963 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
964 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
965 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200966
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009673.3. Debugging
968--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200969
970debug
971 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
972 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
973 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
974 system startup.
975
976quiet
977 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
978 line argument "-q".
979
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200980
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009813.4. Userlists
982--------------
983It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
984http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
985it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
986
987userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100988 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100989 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
990
991group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100992 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100993 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
994 proceeded by "users" keyword.
995
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100996user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
997 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100998 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
999 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001000 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1001 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001002 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
1003 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
1004
1005
1006 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001007 userlist L1
1008 group G1 users tiger,scott
1009 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001010
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001011 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1012 user scott insecure-password elgato
1013 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001014
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001015 userlist L2
1016 group G1
1017 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001018
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001019 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1020 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1021 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001022
1023 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001025
10263.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001027----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001028It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1029haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1030pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1031identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1032or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1033Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1034known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1035the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1036process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1037during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1038tables.
1039
1040peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001041 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001042 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1043
1044peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1045 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1046 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1047 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1048 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1049 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1050 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1051
1052 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1053 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1054
1055 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1056 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1057 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1058 across all peers.
1059
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001060 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1061 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1062 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1063
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001064 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001065 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001066 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1067 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1068 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001069
1070 backend mybackend
1071 mode tcp
1072 balance roundrobin
1073 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1074 stick on src
1075
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001076 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1077 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001078
1079
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010804. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001081----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001082
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001083Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1084 - defaults <name>
1085 - frontend <name>
1086 - backend <name>
1087 - listen <name>
1088
1089A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1090its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1091section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001092section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001093
1094A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1095connections.
1096
1097A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1098to forward incoming connections.
1099
1100A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1101parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1102
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001103All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1104'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1105case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1106
1107Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1108logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1109proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1110However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1111name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1112
1113Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1114and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001115bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001116protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1117modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1118arbitrary criteria.
1119
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001120
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011214.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1122--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001123
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001124The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1125limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1126they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1127limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001128marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001129option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001130and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1131with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1132specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001133
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001134
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001135 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1136------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1137acl - X X X
1138appsession - - X X
1139backlog X X X -
1140balance X - X X
1141bind - X X -
1142bind-process X X X X
1143block - X X X
1144capture cookie - X X -
1145capture request header - X X -
1146capture response header - X X -
1147clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001148compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001149contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1150cookie X - X X
1151default-server X - X X
1152default_backend X X X -
1153description - X X X
1154disabled X X X X
1155dispatch - - X X
1156enabled X X X X
1157errorfile X X X X
1158errorloc X X X X
1159errorloc302 X X X X
1160-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1161errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001162force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001163fullconn X - X X
1164grace X X X X
1165hash-type X - X X
1166http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001167http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001168http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001169http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001170http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02001171tcp-check expect - - X X
1172tcp-check send - - X X
1173tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001174http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001175id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001176ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001177log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001178maxconn X X X -
1179mode X X X X
1180monitor fail - X X -
1181monitor-net X X X -
1182monitor-uri X X X -
1183option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1184option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1185option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1186option allbackups (*) X - X X
1187option checkcache (*) X - X X
1188option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1189option contstats (*) X X X -
1190option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1191option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1192option forceclose (*) X X X X
1193-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1194option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001195option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001196option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001197option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001198option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1199option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1200option httpchk X - X X
1201option httpclose (*) X X X X
1202option httplog X X X X
1203option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001204option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001205option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001206option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1207option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1208option logasap (*) X X X -
1209option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001210option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001211option nolinger (*) X X X X
1212option originalto X X X X
1213option persist (*) X - X X
1214option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001215option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001216option smtpchk X - X X
1217option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1218option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1219option splice-request (*) X X X X
1220option splice-response (*) X X X X
1221option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1222option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1223-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001224option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001225option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1226option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1227option tcpka X X X X
1228option tcplog X X X X
1229option transparent (*) X - X X
1230persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1231rate-limit sessions X X X -
1232redirect - X X X
1233redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1234redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1235reqadd - X X X
1236reqallow - X X X
1237reqdel - X X X
1238reqdeny - X X X
1239reqiallow - X X X
1240reqidel - X X X
1241reqideny - X X X
1242reqipass - X X X
1243reqirep - X X X
1244reqisetbe - X X X
1245reqitarpit - X X X
1246reqpass - X X X
1247reqrep - X X X
1248-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1249reqsetbe - X X X
1250reqtarpit - X X X
1251retries X - X X
1252rspadd - X X X
1253rspdel - X X X
1254rspdeny - X X X
1255rspidel - X X X
1256rspideny - X X X
1257rspirep - X X X
1258rsprep - X X X
1259server - - X X
1260source X - X X
1261srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001262stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001263stats auth X - X X
1264stats enable X - X X
1265stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001266stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001267stats realm X - X X
1268stats refresh X - X X
1269stats scope X - X X
1270stats show-desc X - X X
1271stats show-legends X - X X
1272stats show-node X - X X
1273stats uri X - X X
1274-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1275stick match - - X X
1276stick on - - X X
1277stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001278stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001279stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001280tcp-request connection - X X -
1281tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001282tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001283tcp-response content - - X X
1284tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001285timeout check X - X X
1286timeout client X X X -
1287timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1288timeout connect X - X X
1289timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1290timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1291timeout http-request X X X X
1292timeout queue X - X X
1293timeout server X - X X
1294timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1295timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001296timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001297transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001298unique-id-format X X X -
1299unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001300use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001301use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001302------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1303 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001304
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001305
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013064.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1307---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001308
1309This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1310
1311
1312acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1313 Declare or complete an access list.
1314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1315 no | yes | yes | yes
1316 Example:
1317 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1318 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1319 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1320
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001321 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001322
1323
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001324appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1325 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001326 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1328 no | no | yes | yes
1329 Arguments :
1330 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1331 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1332
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001333 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001334 checked in each cookie value.
1335
1336 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1337 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1338 milliseconds.
1339
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001340 request-learn
1341 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1342 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1343 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1344 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1345 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1346 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1347
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001348 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1349 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1350 data following this prefix.
1351
1352 Example :
1353 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1354
1355 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1356 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1357
1358 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1359 2 modes are currently supported :
1360 - path-parameters :
1361 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1362 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1363 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1364 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1365 - query-string :
1366 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1367 query string.
1368
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001369 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1370 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1371 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1372 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001373 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1374 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1375 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001376 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1377 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1378
1379 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1380
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001381 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1382 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1383 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1384
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001385 Example :
1386 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1387
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001388 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1389 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001390
1391
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001392backlog <conns>
1393 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1395 yes | yes | yes | no
1396 Arguments :
1397 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1398 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001399 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001400
1401 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1402 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1403 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1404 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1405 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1406 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1407 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1408 backlog parameter.
1409
1410 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1411 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1412 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1413
1414 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1415
1416
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001417balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001418balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001419 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1421 yes | no | yes | yes
1422 Arguments :
1423 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1424 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1425 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1426 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1427
1428 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1429 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1430 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1431 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001432 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001433 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001434 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1435 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1436 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1437 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1438 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1439 it, so that you don't worry.
1440
1441 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1442 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1443 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1444 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1445 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1446 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1447 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1448 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001449
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001450 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1451 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1452 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1453 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1454 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1455 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1456 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1457 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1458
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001459 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1460 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1461 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1462 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001463 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001464 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1465 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1466 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1467 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1468 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001469 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1470 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1471 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1472 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1473 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1474 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001475
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001476 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1477 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1478 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1479 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1480 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1481 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1482 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1483 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001484 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001485 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001486 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1487 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1488 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001489
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001490 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1491 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1492 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1493 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1494 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1495 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1496 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1497 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1498 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1499 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1500 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1501 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001502
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001503 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001504 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1505 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1506 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1507 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1508 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1509 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1510 URIs start with a leading "/".
1511
1512 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1513 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1514 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1515 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1516
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001517 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001518 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1519
1520 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001521 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1522 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1523 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1524 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1525 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1526 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1527 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1528 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1529 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1530 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1531 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1532 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1533 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1534 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1535 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1536 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1537 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1538 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1539 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001540
1541 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1542 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1543 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1544 server will receive the request.
1545
1546 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1547 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1548 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1549 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1550 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001551 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1552 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1553 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001554
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001555 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1556 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1557 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1558 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1559 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001560
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001561 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001562 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1563 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1564 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1565
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001566 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1567 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1568 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1569
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001570 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001571 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001572 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1573 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1574 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1575 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1576 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1577 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001578 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001579 used instead.
1580
1581 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1582 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1583 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1584 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1585
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001586 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1587 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1588 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1589
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001590 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001591
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001592 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001593 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1594 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001595
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001596 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001597 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001598
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001599 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1600 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1601 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001602
1603 Examples :
1604 balance roundrobin
1605 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001606 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001607 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1608 balance hdr(host)
1609 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001610
1611 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1612 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1613
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001614 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001615 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1616 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1617 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1618 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1619
1620 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1621 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1622 defaults to 16 kB.
1623
1624 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1625 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1626
1627 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1628 Round Robin.
1629
1630 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1631 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1632 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1633 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1634
1635 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1636
1637 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001638 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001639 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1640 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1641 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001642
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001643 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1644 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001645
1646
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001647bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1648bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001649 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1651 no | yes | yes | no
1652 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001653 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1654 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1655 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1656 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001657 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001658 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1659 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1660 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1661 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1662 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1663 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1664 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001665 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1666 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1667 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001668 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1669 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1670 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1671 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001672
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001673 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1674 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001675 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1676 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1677 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001678 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1679 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1680 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1681 the range.
1682
1683 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1684 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1685 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1686 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1687 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1688 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1689 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001690 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001691 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001692
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001693 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1694 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1695 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1696 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1697 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1698 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1699 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1700 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1701
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001702 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1703 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1704 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1705 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001706
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001707 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1708 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1709 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1710 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1711 in a frontend.
1712
1713 Example :
1714 listen http_proxy
1715 bind :80,:443
1716 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001717 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001718
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001719 listen http_https_proxy
1720 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001721 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001722
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001723 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1724 bind ipv6@:80
1725 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1726 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1727
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001728 listen external_bind_app1
1729 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1730
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001731 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001732 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001733
1734
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001735bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001736 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1738 yes | yes | yes | yes
1739 Arguments :
1740 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1741 may be used to override a default value.
1742
1743 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1744 option may be combined with other numbers.
1745
1746 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1747 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1748 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1749 missing from all processes.
1750
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001751 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1752 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1753 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1754 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1755 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001756
1757 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1758 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1759 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1760 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1761 and 'even' instances.
1762
1763 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1764 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1765 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1766 32.
1767
1768 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1769 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1770
1771 Example :
1772 listen app_ip1
1773 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001774 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001775
1776 listen app_ip2
1777 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001778 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001779
1780 listen management
1781 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001782 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001783
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001784 listen management
1785 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1786 bind-process 1-4
1787
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001788 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1789
1790
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001791block { if | unless } <condition>
1792 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1794 no | yes | yes | yes
1795
1796 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1797 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001798 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001799 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001800 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1801 "block" statements per instance.
1802
1803 Example:
1804 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1805 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1806 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1807 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1808
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001809 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001810
1811
1812capture cookie <name> len <length>
1813 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1815 no | yes | yes | no
1816 Arguments :
1817 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1818 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1819 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1820 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1821 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1822
1823 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1824 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1825 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1826 right if it exceeds <length>.
1827
1828 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1829 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1830 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1831 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1832
1833 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1834 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1835 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1836
1837 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1838 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1839 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001840 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1841 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1842 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001843
1844 Example:
1845 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1846
1847 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001848 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001849
1850
1851capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001852 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1854 no | yes | yes | no
1855 Arguments :
1856 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001857 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001858 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1859 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1860 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1861
1862 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1863 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1864 it exceeds <length>.
1865
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001866 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001867 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1868 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001869 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1870 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1871 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1872 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001873 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001874 environments to find where the request came from.
1875
1876 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1877 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1878 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1879 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001880
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001881 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1882 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1883 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1884 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1885 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001886
1887 Example:
1888 capture request header Host len 15
1889 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1890 capture request header Referrer len 15
1891
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001892 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001893 about logging.
1894
1895
1896capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001897 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1899 no | yes | yes | no
1900 Arguments :
1901 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001902 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001903 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1904 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1905 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1906
1907 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1908 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1909 it exceeds <length>.
1910
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001911 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001912 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1913 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1914 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001915 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1916 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1917 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1918 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001919
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001920 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
1921 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1922 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1923 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1924 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001925
1926 Example:
1927 capture response header Content-length len 9
1928 capture response header Location len 15
1929
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001930 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001931 about logging.
1932
1933
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001934clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001935 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1937 yes | yes | yes | no
1938 Arguments :
1939 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1940 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1941 as explained at the top of this document.
1942
1943 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1944 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1945 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1946 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1947 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1948 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1949 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1950 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001951 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001952 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1953 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1954
1955 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1956 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1957 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1958 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1959 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1960 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1961
1962 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1963 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1964
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001965 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1966 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001967
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001968compression algo <algorithm> ...
1969compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001970compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001971 Enable HTTP compression.
1972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1973 yes | yes | yes | yes
1974 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001975 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1976 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1977 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1978
1979 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001980 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001981 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
1982 data.
1983
1984 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
1985 support for zlib was built in.
1986
1987 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
1988 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
1989 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
1990 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
1991 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
1992 in.
1993
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001994 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001995 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001996 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
1997 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
1998 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
1999 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2000 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002001
2002 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2003 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2004 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2005 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2006 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002007 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2008 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2009 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2010 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2011 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
2012 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002013
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002014 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002015 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2016 "Accept-Encoding" header
2017 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002018 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002019 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2020 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002021 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2022 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2023 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2024 "multipart"
2025 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2026 header
2027 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2028 and later
2029 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2030 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002031
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002032 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2033 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002034
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002035 Examples :
2036 compression algo gzip
2037 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002038
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002039contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002040 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2042 yes | no | yes | yes
2043 Arguments :
2044 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2045 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2046 as explained at the top of this document.
2047
2048 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002049 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002050 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002051 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2052 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2053 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2054 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2055
2056 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2057 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2058 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2059 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2060 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2061 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2062
2063 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2064 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2065 instead.
2066
2067 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2068 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2069
2070
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002071cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002072 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2073 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002074 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2076 yes | no | yes | yes
2077 Arguments :
2078 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2079 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2080 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2081 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2082 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2083 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2084 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2085 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2086 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2087
2088 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2089 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2090 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2091 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2092 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2093 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2094 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2095 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2096 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2097 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2098 "insert" and "prefix".
2099
2100 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002101 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002102
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002103 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002104 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2105 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2106 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2107 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2108 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2109 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2110 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2111 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2112 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2113 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002114
2115 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2116 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2117 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2118 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2119 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2120 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2121 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2122 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2123 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2124 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002125 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2126 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2127 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002128
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002129 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2130 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2131 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002132 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2133 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2134 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2135 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002136 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2137 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2138 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002139
2140 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2141 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2142 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2143 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2144 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2145 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2146 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2147 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2148 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2149
2150 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2151 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2152 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2153 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2154 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2155 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2156 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2157 persistence cookie in the cache.
2158 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2159
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002160 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2161 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2162 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2163 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2164 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2165 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2166 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2167 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2168 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2169 they logout.
2170
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002171 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2172 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2173 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2174 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2175
2176 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2177 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2178 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2179 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2180 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2181 this attribute.
2182
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002183 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002184 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002185 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2186 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2187 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2188 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2189 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2190 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002191
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002192 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2193 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2194 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2195 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2196 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2197 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2198 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2199 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2200 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2201 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2202 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2203 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2204 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2205 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2206 the site.
2207
2208 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2209 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2210 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2211 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2212 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2213 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2214 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2215 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2216 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2217 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2218 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2219 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2220 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2221 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2222 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2223 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2224
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002225 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2226 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2227 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2228 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002229
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002230 Examples :
2231 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2232 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2233 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002234 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002235
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002236 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002237 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002238
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002239
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002240default-server [param*]
2241 Change default options for a server in a backend
2242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2243 yes | no | yes | yes
2244 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002245 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2246 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2247 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2248 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002249
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002250 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002251 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2252
2253 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002254
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002255
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002256default_backend <backend>
2257 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2259 yes | yes | yes | no
2260 Arguments :
2261 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2262
2263 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2264 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2265 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2266 will catch all undetermined requests.
2267
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002268 Example :
2269
2270 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2271 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2272 default_backend dynamic
2273
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002274 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2275
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002276
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002277description <string>
2278 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2280 no | yes | yes | yes
2281 Arguments : string
2282
2283 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2284 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2285 it describes.
2286 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2287
2288
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002289disabled
2290 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2292 yes | yes | yes | yes
2293 Arguments : none
2294
2295 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2296 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2297 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2298 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2299 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2300 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2301 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2302
2303 See also : "enabled"
2304
2305
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002306dispatch <address>:<port>
2307 Set a default server address
2308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2309 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002310 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002311
2312 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2313 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2314 during start-up.
2315
2316 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2317 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2318 possible with normal servers.
2319
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002320 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002321 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2322 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2323 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2324 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2325
2326 See also : "server"
2327
2328
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002329enabled
2330 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2332 yes | yes | yes | yes
2333 Arguments : none
2334
2335 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2336 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2337
2338 See also : "disabled"
2339
2340
2341errorfile <code> <file>
2342 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2344 yes | yes | yes | yes
2345 Arguments :
2346 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002347 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002348
2349 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002350 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002351 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002352 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2353 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002354
2355 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2356 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2357 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2358
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002359 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2360
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002361 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2362 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2363 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2364 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2365
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002366 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2367 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2368 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2369 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2370 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2371 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002373 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2374 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2375 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002376 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002377 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2378
2379 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2380
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002381 Example :
2382 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2383 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2384 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2385
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002386
2387errorloc <code> <url>
2388errorloc302 <code> <url>
2389 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2391 yes | yes | yes | yes
2392 Arguments :
2393 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002394 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002395
2396 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2397 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2398 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2399 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2400 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2401
2402 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2403 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2404 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2405
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002406 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2407
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002408 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2409 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2410 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2411 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2412 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2413 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2414 request.
2415
2416 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2417
2418
2419errorloc303 <code> <url>
2420 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2422 yes | yes | yes | yes
2423 Arguments :
2424 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2425 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2426
2427 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2428 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2429 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2430 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2431 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2432
2433 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2434 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2435 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2436
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002437 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2438
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002439 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2440 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2441 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2442 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002443 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002444
2445 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2446
2447
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002448force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2449 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2450 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2451 no | yes | yes | yes
2452
2453 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2454 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2455 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2456 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2457 marked down for maintenance operations.
2458
2459 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2460 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2461 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2462 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2463 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2464 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2465 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2466 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2467 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2468
2469 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2470 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2471 is used.
2472
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002473 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002474 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002475
2476
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002477fullconn <conns>
2478 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2480 yes | no | yes | yes
2481 Arguments :
2482 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2483 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2484
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002485 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002486 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002487 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002488 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2489 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2490 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2491 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2492 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002493 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002494
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002495 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2496 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2497 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2498
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002499 Example :
2500 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2501 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2502 # connections.
2503 backend dynamic
2504 fullconn 10000
2505 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2506 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2507
2508 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2509
2510
2511grace <time>
2512 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002514 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002515 Arguments :
2516 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2517 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2518 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2519
2520 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2521 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002522 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002523 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2524
2525 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2526 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2527 simplify it.
2528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002529
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002530hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002531 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2533 yes | no | yes | yes
2534 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002535 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2536 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002537
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002538 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2539 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2540 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2541 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2542 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2543 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2544 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2545 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2546 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2547 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002548
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002549 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2550 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2551 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2552 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2553 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2554 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2555 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2556 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2557 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2558 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2559 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2560 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2561 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002562 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2563 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002564
2565 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2566
2567 sdbm this function was created intially for sdbm (a public-domain
2568 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2569 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2570 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002571 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2572 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2573 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002574
2575 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2576 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002577 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2578 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2579 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2580 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2581
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002582 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2583 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2584 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2585 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2586 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2587 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2588 parameter.
2589
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002590 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2591
2592 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2593 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2594 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2595 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2596 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2597 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2598 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2599 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2600 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2601 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2602 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2603 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002604
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002605 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2606 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2607 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002608
2609 See also : "balance", "server"
2610
2611
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002612http-check disable-on-404
2613 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002615 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002616 Arguments : none
2617
2618 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2619 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2620 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2621 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2622 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2623 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2624 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2625 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002626 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2627 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2628 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2629
2630 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2631
2632
2633http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002634 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002636 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002637 Arguments :
2638 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2639 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002640 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002641 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2642 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2643 details on the supported keywords.
2644
2645 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2646 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2647 with the usual backslash ('\').
2648
2649 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2650 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2651 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2652 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2653 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2654
2655 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002656 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002657 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2658 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2659 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2660
2661 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002662 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002663 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2664 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2665 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2666 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2667
2668 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002669 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002670 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2671 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2672 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2673 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2674 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2675 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2676 trace).
2677
2678 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002679 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002680 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2681 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2682 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2683 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2684 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2685 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2686
2687 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2688 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2689 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2690 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2691 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2692 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2693 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2694 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2695
2696 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2697 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2698
2699 Examples :
2700 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002701 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002702
2703 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002704 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002705
2706 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002707 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002708
2709 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002710 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002711
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002712 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002713
2714
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002715http-check send-state
2716 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2718 yes | no | yes | yes
2719 Arguments : none
2720
2721 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2722 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2723 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2724 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2725 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2726
2727 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2728 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2729 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2730 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2731 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2732 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2733 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2734 checked in multiple backends.
2735
2736 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2737 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2738
2739 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2740 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2741 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2742 one fails.
2743
2744 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2745 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2746 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2747
2748 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2749 server's queue.
2750
2751 Example of a header received by the application server :
2752 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2753 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2754
2755 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2756
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002757http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002758 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002759 set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> | set-tos <tos> |
2760 set-mark <mark> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002761 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002762 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2763
2764 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2765 no | yes | yes | yes
2766
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002767 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2768 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2769 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2770 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2771 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002772
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002773 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2774 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2775 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2776
2777 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2778 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2779 are evaluated.
2780
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002781 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2782 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2783 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2784 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2785 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2786 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2787 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2788 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2789 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
2790 developped robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
2791 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2792
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002793 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2794 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2795 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2796 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2797 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2798
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002799 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2800 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2801 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002802 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2803 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002804
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002805 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2806 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2807 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2808 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2809 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2810 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2811 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2812 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2813
2814 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2815 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2816 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2817 external users.
2818
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002819 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2820 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2821 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2822 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2823 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2824 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2825 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2826 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2827
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002828 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2829 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2830 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2831 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2832 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2833 another equipment.
2834
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002835 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2836 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2837 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2838 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2839 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2840 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2841 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2842 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2843
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002844 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2845 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2846 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2847 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2848 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2849 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2850 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2851 admin privileges.
2852
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002853 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2854
2855 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2856 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2857 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2858 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002859
2860 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002861 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2862 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2863 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002864
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002865 http-request allow if nagios
2866 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2867 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2868 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002869
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002870 Example:
2871 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002872 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002873
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002874 Example:
2875 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2876 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2877 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2878 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2879 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2880 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2881 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2882 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2883 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2884
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002885 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2886 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002887
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002888http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002889 set-header <name> <fmt> | set-log-level <level> |
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02002890 set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> }
2891 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002892 Access control for Layer 7 responses
2893
2894 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2895 no | yes | yes | yes
2896
2897 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2898 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2899 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2900 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2901 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
2902 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
2903
2904 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2905 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
2906 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
2907 current section.
2908
2909 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2910 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
2911 rules are evaluated.
2912
2913 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2914 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2915 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
2916 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
2917 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
2918 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
2919 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
2920
2921 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2922 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2923 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2924 external users.
2925
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002926 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2927 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2928 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2929 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2930 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2931 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2932 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2933 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2934
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002935 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2936 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2937 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2938 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2939 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2940 another equipment.
2941
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002942 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2943 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2944 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2945 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2946 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2947 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2948 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2949 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2950
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002951 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2952 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2953 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2954 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2955 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2956 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2957 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2958 admin privileges.
2959
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002960 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
2961
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08002962 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002963 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
2964 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
2965 rules.
2966
2967 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
2968 ACL usage.
2969
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02002970
2971tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2972 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
2973 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2974 no | no | yes | yes
2975
2976 Arguments :
2977 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2978 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
2979 binary.
2980 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
2981 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
2982 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
2983
2984 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2985 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2986 with the usual backslash ('\').
2987 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
2988 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
2989 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
2990 used upper or lower case.
2991
2992
2993 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
2994
2995 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
2996 A health check response will be considered valid if the
2997 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
2998 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2999 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3000 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
3001 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
3002 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
3003
3004 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
3005 A health check response will be considered valid if the
3006 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
3007 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3008 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
3009 expression.
3010
3011 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
3012 in the response buffer. A health check response will
3013 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
3014 this exact hexadecimal string.
3015 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
3016
3017 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3018 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3019 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3020 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
3021 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3022 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3023 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3024 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
3025 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
3026 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
3027 the null character.
3028
3029 Examples :
3030 # perform a POP check
3031 option tcp-check
3032 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
3033
3034 # perform an IMAP check
3035 option tcp-check
3036 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
3037
3038 # look for the redis master server
3039 option tcp-check
3040 tcp-check send PING\r\n
3041 tcp-check expect +PONG
3042 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3043 tcp-check expect string role:master
3044 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
3045 tcp-check expect string +OK
3046
3047
3048 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "http-check expect",
3049 tune.chksize
3050
3051
3052tcp-check send <data>
3053 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3054 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3055 no | no | yes | yes
3056
3057 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3058 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3059
3060 Examples :
3061 # look for the redis master server
3062 option tcp-check
3063 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3064 tcp-check expect string role:master
3065
3066 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send-binary",
3067 tune.chksize
3068
3069
3070tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
3071 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
3072 tcp health check
3073 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3074 no | no | yes | yes
3075
3076 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3077 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3078 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
3079 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
3080 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
3081 hexadecimal string.
3082 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
3083
3084 Examples :
3085 # redis check in binary
3086 option tcp-check
3087 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
3088 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
3089
3090
3091 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send",
3092 tune.chksize
3093
3094
3095
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003096http-send-name-header [<header>]
3097 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3098
3099 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3100 yes | no | yes | yes
3101
3102 Arguments :
3103
3104 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3105
3106 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3107 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3108 is added with the header string proved.
3109
3110 See also : "server"
3111
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003112id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003113 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3115 no | yes | yes | yes
3116 Arguments : none
3117
3118 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3119 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3120 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003121
3122
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003123ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3124 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3125 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3126 no | yes | yes | yes
3127
3128 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3129 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3130 and running).
3131
3132 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3133 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3134 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
3135 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
3136 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3137
3138 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3139 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3140
3141 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3142 "unless" condition is met.
3143
3144 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3145
3146
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003147log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003148log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003149no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003150 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3152 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003153
3154 Prefix :
3155 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3156 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3157 prefix does not allow arguments.
3158
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003159 Arguments :
3160 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3161 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3162 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3163 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3164 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3165 parameter.
3166
3167 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3168 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3169
3170 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3171 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3172 standard syslog port).
3173
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003174 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3175 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3176 standard syslog port).
3177
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003178 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3179 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3180 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3181 appropriately writeable).
3182
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003183 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3184 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3185 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3186 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3187
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003188 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3189
3190 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3191 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3192 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3193
3194 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3195 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3196 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003197 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3198 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3199 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3200 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3201 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003202
3203 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3204
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003205 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3206 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3207 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003208
3209 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3210 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3211 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3212 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3213
3214 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3215 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003216
3217 Example :
3218 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003219 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3220 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003221 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3222
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003223
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003224log-format <string>
3225 Allows you to custom a log line.
3226
3227 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3228
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003229
3230maxconn <conns>
3231 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3233 yes | yes | yes | no
3234 Arguments :
3235 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3236 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3237 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3238 closes.
3239
3240 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3241 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3242 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3243 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3244 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3245 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3246 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3247 properly tuned.
3248
3249 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3250 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3251 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3252
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003253 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3254
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003255 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3256
3257
3258mode { tcp|http|health }
3259 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3261 yes | yes | yes | yes
3262 Arguments :
3263 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3264 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3265 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3266 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3267
3268 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3269 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3270 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3271 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3272 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3273
3274 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003275 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3276 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3277 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3278 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3279 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3280 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3281 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003282
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003283 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3284 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3285 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003286
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003287 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003288 defaults http_instances
3289 mode http
3290
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003291 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003292
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003293
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003294monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003295 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3297 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003298 Arguments :
3299 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3300 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003301 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003302 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3303 backend and its backup.
3304
3305 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3306 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3307 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3308 servers in a list of backends.
3309
3310 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3311 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3312 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3313 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3314 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3315 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3316 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003317 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3318 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003319
3320 Example:
3321 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003322 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003323 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3324 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3325 monitor-uri /site_alive
3326 monitor fail if site_dead
3327
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003328 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003329
3330
3331monitor-net <source>
3332 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3334 yes | yes | yes | no
3335 Arguments :
3336 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3337 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3338 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3339 followed by a mask.
3340
3341 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3342 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003343 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003344 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3345
3346 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3347 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3348 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3349 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003350 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3351 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3352 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003353
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003354 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3355 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3356 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3357 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3358 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3359 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003360
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003361 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3362 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003363
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003364 Example :
3365 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3366 frontend www
3367 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3368
3369 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3370
3371
3372monitor-uri <uri>
3373 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3375 yes | yes | yes | no
3376 Arguments :
3377 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3378 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3379
3380 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3381 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3382 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3383 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3384 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3385 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3386 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3387 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3388
3389 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3390 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3391 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3392 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3393 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3394 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3395
3396 Example :
3397 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3398 frontend www
3399 mode http
3400 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3401
3402 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3403
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003404
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003405option abortonclose
3406no option abortonclose
3407 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3409 yes | no | yes | yes
3410 Arguments : none
3411
3412 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3413 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3414 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3415 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003416 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003417 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3418 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3419 encountered while delivering the response.
3420
3421 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3422 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3423 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3424 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3425 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3426 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003427 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003428 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003429 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003430 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3431 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3432 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3433
3434 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3435 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3436 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3437 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3438 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3439 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3440 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3441 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003442 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003443
3444 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3445 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3446
3447 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3448
3449
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003450option accept-invalid-http-request
3451no option accept-invalid-http-request
3452 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3454 yes | yes | yes | no
3455 Arguments : none
3456
3457 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3458 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3459 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3460 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3461 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3462 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3463 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3464 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003465 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3466 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3467 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3468 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3469 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3470 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003471
3472 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3473 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3474 been confirmed.
3475
3476 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3477 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003478 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3479 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003480 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3481
3482 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3483 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3484
3485 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3486 stats socket.
3487
3488
3489option accept-invalid-http-response
3490no option accept-invalid-http-response
3491 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3493 yes | no | yes | yes
3494 Arguments : none
3495
3496 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3497 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3498 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3499 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3500 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3501 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3502 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3503 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3504 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3505
3506 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3507 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3508 been confirmed.
3509
3510 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3511 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3512 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3513 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3514
3515 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3516 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3517
3518 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3519 stats socket.
3520
3521
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003522option allbackups
3523no option allbackups
3524 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3526 yes | no | yes | yes
3527 Arguments : none
3528
3529 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3530 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3531 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3532 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3533 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3534 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3535 order between the backup servers anymore.
3536
3537 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3538 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3539
3540 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3541 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3542
3543
3544option checkcache
3545no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003546 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3548 yes | no | yes | yes
3549 Arguments : none
3550
3551 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3552 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003553 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003554 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3555 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003556 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003557
3558 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003559 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003560 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003561 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3562 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003563 to the client are :
3564 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003565 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003566 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003567 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3568 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3569 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3570 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3571 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3572 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3573 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3574 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3575 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3576 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3577 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3578
3579 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003580 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003581 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003582 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003583 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3584
3585 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3586 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003587 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003588 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3589
3590 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3591 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3592
3593
3594option clitcpka
3595no option clitcpka
3596 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3598 yes | yes | yes | no
3599 Arguments : none
3600
3601 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3602 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3603 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3604 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3605
3606 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3607 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3608 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3609 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3610
3611 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3612 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3613 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3614 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3615 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3616
3617 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3618
3619 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3620 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3621 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3622
3623 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3624 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3625
3626 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3627
3628
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003629option contstats
3630 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3632 yes | yes | yes | no
3633 Arguments : none
3634
3635 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3636 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3637 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3638 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3639 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3640 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3641 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3642
3643
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003644option dontlog-normal
3645no option dontlog-normal
3646 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3648 yes | yes | yes | no
3649 Arguments : none
3650
3651 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3652 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3653 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3654 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3655 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3656 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3657 logged.
3658
3659 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3660 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3661 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3662
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003663 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003664 logging.
3665
3666
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003667option dontlognull
3668no option dontlognull
3669 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3671 yes | yes | yes | no
3672 Arguments : none
3673
3674 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3675 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3676 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3677 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3678 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3679 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3680 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3681
3682 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3683 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3684 would not be logged.
3685
3686 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3687 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3688
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003689 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003690
3691
3692option forceclose
3693no option forceclose
3694 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003696 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003697 Arguments : none
3698
3699 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3700 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3701 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3702 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3703 global session times in the logs.
3704
3705 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003706 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003707 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3708 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3709 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3710 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003711
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003712 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3713 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3714 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3715
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003716 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3717 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3718
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003719 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003720
3721
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003722option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003723 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3725 yes | yes | yes | yes
3726 Arguments :
3727 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3728 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003729 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003730 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003731
3732 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3733 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3734 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3735 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3736 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3737 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3738 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003739 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3740 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3741 possible that the client has already brought one.
3742
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003743 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003744 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003745 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3746 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003747 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3748 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003749
3750 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3751 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3752 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3753 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3754 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3755 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3756 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3757
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003758 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3759 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3760 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3761 are under the control of the end-user.
3762
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003763 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003764 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3765 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003766 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3767 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3768 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003769
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003770 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3771 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3772 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3773 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3774 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003775
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003776 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003777 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3778 frontend www
3779 mode http
3780 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3781
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003782 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3783 backend www
3784 mode http
3785 option forwardfor header X-Client
3786
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003787 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3788 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003789
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003790
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003791option http-keep-alive
3792no option http-keep-alive
3793 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
3794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3795 yes | yes | yes | yes
3796 Arguments : none
3797
3798 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3799 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3800 "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client- and
3801 server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3802 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
3803 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
3804 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
3805 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
3806 situations where this option may be useful :
3807
3808 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
3809 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
3810
3811 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
3812 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
3813
3814 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
3815 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
3816 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
3817 request.
3818
3819 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
3820 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003821 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
3822 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
3823 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003824
3825 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
3826 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
3827
3828 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3829 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3830 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3831 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
3832 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3833 not set.
3834
3835 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3836 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3837 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3838 have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
3839
3840 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3841 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3842
3843 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003844 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3845 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003846
3847
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003848option http-no-delay
3849no option http-no-delay
3850 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3852 yes | yes | yes | yes
3853 Arguments : none
3854
3855 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3856 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3857 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3858 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3859 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3860 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3861 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3862 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3863 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3864 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3865 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3866 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3867 affected.
3868
3869 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3870 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3871 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3872 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3873 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3874 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3875 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3876 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3877 latency environments.
3878
3879
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003880option http-pretend-keepalive
3881no option http-pretend-keepalive
3882 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3884 yes | yes | yes | yes
3885 Arguments : none
3886
3887 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3888 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3889 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3890 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3891 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3892 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3893 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3894 consider the response complete.
3895
3896 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3897 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3898 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3899 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3900 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3901 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3902
3903 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3904 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3905 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3906 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3907 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3908 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3909 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3910
3911 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3912 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003913 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003914 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3915 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003916
3917 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3918 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3919
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003920 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
3921 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003922
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003923
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003924option http-server-close
3925no option http-server-close
3926 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3928 yes | yes | yes | yes
3929 Arguments : none
3930
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003931 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3932 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3933 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3934 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3935 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3936 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3937 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3938 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3939 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3940 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3941 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3942 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003943
3944 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3945 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3946 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3947 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003948 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3949 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003950
3951 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3952 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003953 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3954 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3955 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003956
3957 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3958 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3959
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003960 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003961 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
3962 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003963
3964
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003965option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003966no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003967 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3969 yes | yes | yes | no
3970 Arguments : none
3971
3972 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3973 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3974 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3975 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3976 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3977 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3978 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3979
3980 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3981 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3982 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3983 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3984 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3985 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3986 request along its whole life.
3987
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003988 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3989 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3990 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3991 front of an existing proxy.
3992
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003993 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3994
3995 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3996 http-server-close".
3997
3998
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003999option httpchk
4000option httpchk <uri>
4001option httpchk <method> <uri>
4002option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4003 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4005 yes | no | yes | yes
4006 Arguments :
4007 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4008 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4009 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4010 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4011 ones.
4012
4013 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4014 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4015 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4016
4017 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4018 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4019 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4020 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4021 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4022
4023 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4024 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4025 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4026 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4027 the lack of any response.
4028
4029 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4030
4031 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4032 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4033 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4034
4035 Examples :
4036 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4037 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4038 backend https_relay
4039 mode tcp
4040 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4041 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4042
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004043 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4044 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4045 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004046
4047
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004048option httpclose
4049no option httpclose
4050 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4052 yes | yes | yes | yes
4053 Arguments : none
4054
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004055 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
4056 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
4057 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
4058 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
4059 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
4060 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
4061 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004062
4063 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004064 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004065 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4066 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4067 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4068 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4069 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004070
4071 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4072 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
4073 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004074 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
4075 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004076
4077 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4078 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4079
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004080 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4081 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004082
4083
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004084option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004085 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4087 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004088 Arguments :
4089 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4090 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4091 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4092 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4093 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004094
4095 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4096 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4097 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4098 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4099 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4100 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4101 ports.
4102
4103 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4104
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004105 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4106 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4107 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4108 by default.
4109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004110 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004111
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004112
4113option http_proxy
4114no option http_proxy
4115 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4117 yes | yes | yes | yes
4118 Arguments : none
4119
4120 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4121 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4122 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4123 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4124 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4125
4126 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4127 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4128 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4129 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004130 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004131 be analyzed.
4132
4133 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4134 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4135
4136 Example :
4137 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4138 backend direct_forward
4139 option httpclose
4140 option http_proxy
4141
4142 See also : "option httpclose"
4143
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004144
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004145option independent-streams
4146no option independent-streams
4147 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4149 yes | yes | yes | yes
4150 Arguments : none
4151
4152 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4153 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4154 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4155 receive data or not.
4156
4157 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4158 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4159 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4160 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4161 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4162 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4163 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4164 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4165 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4166 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4167 socket buffers.
4168
4169 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4170 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4171 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4172 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4173 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4174
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004175 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
4176 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4177 deprecated.
4178
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004179 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004180
4181
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004182option ldap-check
4183 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4185 yes | no | yes | yes
4186 Arguments : none
4187
4188 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4189 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4190 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4191 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4192
4193 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4194 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4195
4196 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4197 configure it.
4198
4199 Example :
4200 option ldap-check
4201
4202 See also : "option httpchk"
4203
4204
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004205option log-health-checks
4206no option log-health-checks
4207 Enable or disable logging of health checks
4208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4209 yes | no | yes | yes
4210 Arguments : none
4211
4212 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
4213 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
4214 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
4215 of additional information is limited.
4216
4217 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
4218 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
4219
4220 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
4221
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004222
4223option log-separate-errors
4224no option log-separate-errors
4225 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4227 yes | yes | yes | no
4228 Arguments : none
4229
4230 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4231 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4232 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4233 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4234 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4235 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4236 provides very important information.
4237
4238 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4239 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4240 error logs.
4241
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004242 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004243 logging.
4244
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004245
4246option logasap
4247no option logasap
4248 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4250 yes | yes | yes | no
4251 Arguments : none
4252
4253 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4254 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4255 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4256 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4257 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4258 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4259 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004260 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004261 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4262 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4263
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004264 Examples :
4265 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4266 mode http
4267 option httplog
4268 option logasap
4269 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4270
4271 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4272 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4273 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4274 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4275
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004276 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004277 logging.
4278
4279
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004280option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4281 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4283 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004284 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004285 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4286 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004287
4288 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4289 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4290 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4291 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4292 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4293 in the MySQL table, like this :
4294
4295 USE mysql;
4296 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4297 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4298
4299 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4300 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4301 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4302 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4303 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4304 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4305 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4306 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4307 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4308
4309 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4310 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004311
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004312 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004313
4314 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4315 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4316 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4317 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4318 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4319 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4320
4321 See also: "option httpchk"
4322
4323
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004324option nolinger
4325no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004326 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004327 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4328 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004329 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004330
4331 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4332 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4333 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4334 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4335 connections.
4336
4337 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4338 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4339 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4340 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4341 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4342 this too.
4343
4344 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4345 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4346 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4347
4348 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4349 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4350 for servers.
4351
4352 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4353 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4354
4355
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004356option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4357 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4359 yes | yes | yes | yes
4360 Arguments :
4361 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4362 matching <network>
4363 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4364 header name.
4365
4366 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4367 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4368 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4369 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4370 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4371 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4372 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4373 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4374 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4375 possible that the client has already brought one.
4376
4377 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4378 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4379 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4380 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4381 header and requires different one.
4382
4383 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4384 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4385 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4386 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4387 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4388 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4389 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4390
4391 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4392 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4393 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4394 both are defined.
4395
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004396 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
4397 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
4398 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
4399 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
4400 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004401
4402 Examples :
4403 # Original Destination address
4404 frontend www
4405 mode http
4406 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4407
4408 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4409 backend www
4410 mode http
4411 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4412
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004413 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4414 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004415
4416
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004417option persist
4418no option persist
4419 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4420 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4421 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004422 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004423
4424 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4425 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4426 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4427 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4428 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4429 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4430 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4431 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4432 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4433 redirected to another valid server.
4434
4435 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4436 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4437
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004438 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004439
4440
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004441option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4442 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4444 yes | no | yes | yes
4445 Arguments :
4446 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4447 PostgreSQL server.
4448
4449 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4450 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4451 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4452 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4453
4454 See also: "option httpchk"
4455
4456
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004457option prefer-last-server
4458no option prefer-last-server
4459 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4460 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4461 yes | no | yes | yes
4462 Arguments : none
4463
4464 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4465 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4466 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4467 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4468 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4469 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4470 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4471 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4472 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004473 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4474 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4475 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4476 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4477 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4478 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4479 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004480
4481 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4482 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4483
4484 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4485
4486
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004487option redispatch
4488no option redispatch
4489 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4490 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4491 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004492 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004493
4494 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4495 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4496 be able to access the service anymore.
4497
4498 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4499 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4500
4501 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4502 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4503 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004504
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004505 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4506 "redisp" keywords.
4507
4508 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4509 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4510
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004511 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004512
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004513
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004514option redis-check
4515 Use redis health checks for server testing
4516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4517 yes | no | yes | yes
4518 Arguments : none
4519
4520 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4521 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4522 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4523 find the "+PONG" response message.
4524
4525 Example :
4526 option redis-check
4527
4528 See also : "option httpchk"
4529
4530
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004531option smtpchk
4532option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4533 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4535 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004536 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004537 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4538 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4539 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4540
4541 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4542 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4543 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4544
4545 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4546 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4547 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4548 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4549 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4550 dead server.
4551
4552 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4553 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4554 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4555 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4556
4557 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4558 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4559 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4560 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4561 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4562
4563 Example :
4564 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4565
4566 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4567
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004568
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004569option socket-stats
4570no option socket-stats
4571
4572 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4574 yes | yes | yes | no
4575
4576 Arguments : none
4577
4578
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004579option splice-auto
4580no option splice-auto
4581 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4583 yes | yes | yes | yes
4584 Arguments : none
4585
4586 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4587 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4588 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4589 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004590 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004591 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4592 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4593 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4594 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4595
4596 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4597 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4598 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4599 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4600 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4601 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4602 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4603 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4604 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4605 keyword.
4606
4607 Example :
4608 option splice-auto
4609
4610 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4611 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4612
4613 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4614 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4615
4616
4617option splice-request
4618no option splice-request
4619 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4621 yes | yes | yes | yes
4622 Arguments : none
4623
4624 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004625 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004626 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4627 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4628 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4629 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4630
4631 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4632
4633 Example :
4634 option splice-request
4635
4636 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4637 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4638
4639 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4640 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4641
4642
4643option splice-response
4644no option splice-response
4645 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4647 yes | yes | yes | yes
4648 Arguments : none
4649
4650 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004651 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004652 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4653 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4654 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4655 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4656
4657 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4658
4659 Example :
4660 option splice-response
4661
4662 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4663 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4664
4665 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4666 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4667
4668
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004669option srvtcpka
4670no option srvtcpka
4671 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4673 yes | no | yes | yes
4674 Arguments : none
4675
4676 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4677 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4678 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4679 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4680
4681 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4682 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4683 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4684 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4685
4686 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4687 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4688 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4689 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4690 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4691
4692 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4693
4694 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4695 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4696 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4697
4698 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4699 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4700
4701 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4702
4703
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004704option ssl-hello-chk
4705 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4707 yes | no | yes | yes
4708 Arguments : none
4709
4710 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4711 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4712 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4713 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4714 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4715 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4716 hello message.
4717
4718 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4719 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4720 messages, which is appreciable.
4721
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004722 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4723 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4724 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004725
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004726 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4727
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004728
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004729option tcp-check
4730 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
4731 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4732 yes | no | yes | yes
4733
4734 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
4735 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
4736
4737 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
4738 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
4739 attempt, which remains the default mode.
4740
4741 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentionned : this is
4742 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
4743 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
4744 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
4745 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
4746 only.
4747
4748 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentionned : this is used to test a banner.
4749 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
4750 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
4751 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
4752 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
4753
4754 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentionned : this is
4755 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
4756 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
4757 the maching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
4758 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
4759 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
4760 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
4761 the respective protocols.
4762 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
4763 analysed.
4764
4765 Examples :
4766 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
4767 option tcp-check
4768 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
4769
4770 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
4771 option tcp-check
4772 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
4773
4774 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
4775 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
4776 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 tims)
4777 option tcp-check
4778 tcp-check send PING\r\n
4779 tcp-check expect +PONG
4780 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
4781 tcp-check expect string role:master
4782 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
4783 tcp-check expect string +OK
4784
4785 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
4786 (send many headers before analyzing)
4787 option tcp-check
4788 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
4789 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
4790 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
4791 tcp-check send \r\n
4792 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
4793
4794
4795 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
4796
4797
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004798option tcp-smart-accept
4799no option tcp-smart-accept
4800 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4802 yes | yes | yes | no
4803 Arguments : none
4804
4805 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4806 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4807 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4808 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4809 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4810 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4811
4812 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4813 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4814 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4815 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4816
4817 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4818 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4819 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4820 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4821
4822 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4823 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4824 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4825
4826 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4827 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4828 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4829
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004830 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4831
4832
4833option tcp-smart-connect
4834no option tcp-smart-connect
4835 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4837 yes | no | yes | yes
4838 Arguments : none
4839
4840 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4841 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4842 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4843 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4844 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4845
4846 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4847 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4848 complex.
4849
4850 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4851 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4852 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4853
4854 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4855 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4856
4857 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4858
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004859
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004860option tcpka
4861 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4863 yes | yes | yes | yes
4864 Arguments : none
4865
4866 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4867 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4868 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4869 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4870
4871 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4872 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4873 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4874 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4875
4876 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4877 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4878 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4879 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4880 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4881
4882 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4883
4884 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4885 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4886 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4887 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4888 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4889 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4890 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4891 backends.
4892
4893 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4894
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004895
4896option tcplog
4897 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4899 yes | yes | yes | yes
4900 Arguments : none
4901
4902 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4903 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4904 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4905 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4906 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4907 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4908 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4909 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4910
4911 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4912
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004913 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004914
4915
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004916option transparent
4917no option transparent
4918 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004920 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004921 Arguments : none
4922
4923 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4924 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4925 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4926 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4927 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4928 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4929 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4930 appropriate server.
4931
4932 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4933 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4934
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004935 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004936 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004937
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004938
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004939persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004940persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004941 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4943 yes | no | yes | yes
4944 Arguments :
4945 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004946 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4947 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004948
4949 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4950 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4951 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4952 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4953 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4954 forwarded to this server.
4955
4956 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4957 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4958 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004959 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004960 a single "listen" section.
4961
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004962 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4963 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4964 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4965
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004966 Example :
4967 listen tse-farm
4968 bind :3389
4969 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4970 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4971 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4972 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4973 persist rdp-cookie
4974 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004975 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004976 balance rdp-cookie
4977 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4978 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4979
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004980 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4981 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004982
4983
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004984rate-limit sessions <rate>
4985 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4987 yes | yes | yes | no
4988 Arguments :
4989 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4990 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4991
4992 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4993 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4994 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4995 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4996 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4997 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4998
4999 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5000 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5001 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5002 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5003
5004 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5005 listen smtp
5006 mode tcp
5007 bind :25
5008 rate-limit sessions 10
5009 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5010
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005011 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5012 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5013 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005014
5015 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5016
5017
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005018redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5019redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5020redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005021 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5023 no | yes | yes | yes
5024
5025 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005026 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005027
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005028 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005029 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005030 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5031 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5032 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005033
5034 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5035 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5036 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5037 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5038 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005039 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5040 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5041 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5042 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005043
5044 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5045 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5046 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5047 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5048 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5049 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
5050 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
5051 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005052 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5053 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5054 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005055
5056 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005057 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5058 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5059 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5060 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5061 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5062 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5063 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5064 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005065
5066 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5067 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5068
5069 - "drop-query"
5070 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5071 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5072 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5073 with a location-type redirect.
5074
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005075 - "append-slash"
5076 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5077 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5078 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5079 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5080
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005081 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5082 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5083 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5084 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5085 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5086 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5087 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5088
5089 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5090 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5091 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5092 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5093 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5094 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5095 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005096
5097 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5098 acl clear dst_port 80
5099 acl secure dst_port 8080
5100 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005101 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005102 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005103 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5104
5105 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005106 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5107 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5108 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005109 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005110
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005111 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5112 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5113 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5114
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005115 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005116 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005117
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005118 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5119 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5120 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5121
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005122 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005123
5124
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005125redisp (deprecated)
5126redispatch (deprecated)
5127 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5128 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5129 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005130 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005131
5132 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5133 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5134 be able to access the service anymore.
5135
5136 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5137 redistribute them to a working server.
5138
5139 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5140 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5141 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005142
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005143 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5144 "option redispatch" instead.
5145
5146 See also : "option redispatch"
5147
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005148
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005149reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005150 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5152 no | yes | yes | yes
5153 Arguments :
5154 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5155 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005156 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005157
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005158 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5159 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5160
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005161 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5162 the last header of an HTTP request.
5163
5164 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5165 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5166 responses.
5167
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005168 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5169 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5170 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5171
5172 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5173 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005174
5175
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005176reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5177reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005178 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5180 no | yes | yes | yes
5181 Arguments :
5182 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5183 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5184 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5185 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5186 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5187 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5188 ignores case.
5189
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005190 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5191 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5192
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005193 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5194 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5195 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5196 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005197 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005198
5199 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5200 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5201
5202 Example :
5203 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5204 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5205 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5206
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005207 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5208 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005209
5210
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005211reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5212reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005213 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5215 no | yes | yes | yes
5216 Arguments :
5217 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5218 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5219 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5220 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5221 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5222 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5223
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005224 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5225 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5226
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005227 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5228 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5229 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5230 next servers.
5231
5232 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5233 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5234 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5235
5236 Example :
5237 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5238 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5239 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5240
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005241 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5242 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005243
5244
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005245reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5246reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005247 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5249 no | yes | yes | yes
5250 Arguments :
5251 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5252 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5253 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5254 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5255 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5256 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5257 case.
5258
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005259 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5260 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5261
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005262 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5263 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5264 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5265 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005266 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005267
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005268 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005269 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005270 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005271
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005272 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5273 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5274
5275 Example :
5276 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5277 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5278 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5279
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005280 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5281 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005282
5283
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005284reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5285reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005286 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5288 no | yes | yes | yes
5289 Arguments :
5290 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5291 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5292 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5293 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5294 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5295 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5296 case.
5297
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005298 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5299 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5300
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005301 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5302 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5303 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5304 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5305
5306 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5307 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5308
5309 Example :
5310 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5311 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5312 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5313 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5314
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005315 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5316 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005317
5318
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005319reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5320reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005321 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5323 no | yes | yes | yes
5324 Arguments :
5325 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5326 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5327 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5328 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5329 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5330 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5331
5332 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5333 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5334 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5335 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005336 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005337
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005338 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5339 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5340
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005341 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5342 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5343 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5344
5345 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5346 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5347 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5348 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5349 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5350
5351 Example :
5352 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005353 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005354 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5355 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5356
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005357 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5358 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005359
5360
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005361reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5362reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005363 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5365 no | yes | yes | yes
5366 Arguments :
5367 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5368 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5369 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5370 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5371 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5372 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5373 ignores case.
5374
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005375 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5376 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5377
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005378 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5379 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005380 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5381 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5382 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005383 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5384 not set.
5385
5386 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5387 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5388 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5389 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5390 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5391
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005392 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005393 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5394 # block all others.
5395 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5396 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5397
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005398 # block bad guys
5399 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5400 reqitarpit . if badguys
5401
5402 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5403 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005404
5405
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005406retries <value>
5407 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5408 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5409 yes | no | yes | yes
5410 Arguments :
5411 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5412 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5413 default value is 3.
5414
5415 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5416 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5417 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5418
5419 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5420 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5421
5422 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5423 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5424
5425 See also : "option redispatch"
5426
5427
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005428rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005429 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5431 no | yes | yes | yes
5432 Arguments :
5433 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5434 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005435 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005436
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005437 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5438 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5439
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005440 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5441 the last header of an HTTP response.
5442
5443 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5444 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5445 responses.
5446
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005447 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5448 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005449
5450
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005451rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5452rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005453 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5455 no | yes | yes | yes
5456 Arguments :
5457 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5458 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5459 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5460 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5461 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5462 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5463 ignores case.
5464
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005465 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5466 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5467
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005468 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5469 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005470 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005471 client.
5472
5473 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5474 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5475 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5476
5477 Example :
5478 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005479 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005480
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005481 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5482 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005483
5484
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005485rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5486rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005487 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5489 no | yes | yes | yes
5490 Arguments :
5491 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5492 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5493 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5494 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5495 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5496 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5497 ignores case.
5498
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005499 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5500 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5501
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005502 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5503 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5504 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5505 case-sensitive.
5506
5507 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005508 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5509 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5510 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005511
5512 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5513 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5514
5515 Example :
5516 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5517 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5518
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005519 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5520 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005521
5522
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005523rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5524rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005525 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5527 no | yes | yes | yes
5528 Arguments :
5529 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5530 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5531 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5532 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5533 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5534 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5535 ignores case.
5536
5537 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5538 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5539 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5540 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005541 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005542
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005543 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5544 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5545
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005546 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5547 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5548 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5549
5550 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5551 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5552 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5553 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5554 are not case-sensitive.
5555
5556 Example :
5557 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5558 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5559
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005560 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5561 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005562
5563
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005564server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005565 Declare a server in a backend
5566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5567 no | no | yes | yes
5568 Arguments :
5569 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005570 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005571 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005572
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005573 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5574 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5575 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5576 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005577 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5578 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5579 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5580 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5581 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005582 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5583 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5584 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5585 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5586 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5587 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5588 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005589 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5590 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5591 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5592 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005593
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005594 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005595 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5596 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5597 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5598 adding this value to the client's port.
5599
5600 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5601 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005602 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005603
5604 Examples :
5605 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5606 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005607 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005608 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5609 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5610 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005611
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005612 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5613 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005614
5615
5616source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005617source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005618source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005619 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5621 yes | no | yes | yes
5622 Arguments :
5623 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5624 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005625
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005626 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005627 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5628 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5629 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5630 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5631 supported prefixes are :
5632 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5633 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5634 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005635 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5636 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5637 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5638 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005639
5640 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5641 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005642 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5643 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5644 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005645
5646 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5647 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5648 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5649 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5650 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5651 <addr>.
5652
5653 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5654 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5655 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5656 port.
5657
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005658 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5659 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5660 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5661 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005662 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005663 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5664 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5665 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5666 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5667 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5668 HTTP header.
5669
5670 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5671 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005672 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005673 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5674 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5675 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5676 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5677 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5678 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5679 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5680
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005681 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5682 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5683 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5684 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5685 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5686 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5687
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005688 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5689 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5690 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5691 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5692
5693 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5694 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5695 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5696 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5697 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5698 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5699
5700 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5701 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5702 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5703 there are two methods :
5704
5705 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5706 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5707 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5708 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5709 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5710 of the client ranges may be used.
5711
5712 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5713 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5714 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5715 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5716 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5717 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5718 same session.
5719
5720 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5721 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5722 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5723 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5724 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5725 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5726
5727 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5728 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5729 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005730 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005731
5732 Examples :
5733 backend private
5734 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5735 source 192.168.1.200
5736
5737 backend transparent_ssl1
5738 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5739 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5740
5741 backend transparent_ssl2
5742 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5743 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5744 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5745
5746 backend transparent_ssl3
5747 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5748 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5749 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5750
5751 backend transparent_smtp
5752 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5753 # with Tproxy version 4.
5754 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5755
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005756 backend transparent_http
5757 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5758 # proxy.
5759 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5760
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005761 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005762 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5763
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005764
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005765srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5766 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5768 yes | no | yes | yes
5769 Arguments :
5770 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5771 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5772 as explained at the top of this document.
5773
5774 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5775 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5776 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5777 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5778 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5779 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5780 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5781
5782 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5783 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5784 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5785 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5786 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005787 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005788 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005789 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005790
5791 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5792 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5793 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5794 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5795 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5796 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5797
5798 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5799 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5800
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005801 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5802 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005803
5804
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005805stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5806 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5808 no | no | yes | yes
5809
5810 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5811 matched.
5812
5813 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5814 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5815
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005816 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5817 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5818 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5819
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005820 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5821 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5822 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5823 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005824
5825 Example :
5826 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5827 backend stats_localhost
5828 stats enable
5829 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5830
5831 Example :
5832 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5833 backend stats_auth
5834 stats enable
5835 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5836 stats admin if TRUE
5837
5838 Example :
5839 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5840 userlist stats-auth
5841 group admin users admin
5842 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5843 group readonly users haproxy
5844 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5845
5846 backend stats_auth
5847 stats enable
5848 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5849 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5850 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5851 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5852
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005853 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5854 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5855 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005856
5857
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005858stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5859 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5861 yes | no | yes | yes
5862 Arguments :
5863 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5864
5865 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5866
5867 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5868 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5869 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5870 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5871 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5872 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5873
5874 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5875 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5876 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005877 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005878
5879 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5880 report using "stats scope".
5881
5882 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5883 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5884 unobvious parameters.
5885
5886 Example :
5887 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5888 backend public_www
5889 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5890 stats enable
5891 stats hide-version
5892 stats scope .
5893 stats uri /admin?stats
5894 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5895 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5896 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5897
5898 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5899 backend private_monitoring
5900 stats enable
5901 stats uri /admin?stats
5902 stats refresh 5s
5903
5904 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5905
5906
5907stats enable
5908 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5910 yes | no | yes | yes
5911 Arguments : none
5912
5913 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5914 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5915 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5916 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5917 - stats auth : no authentication
5918 - stats scope : no restriction
5919
5920 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5921 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5922 unobvious parameters.
5923
5924 Example :
5925 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5926 backend public_www
5927 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5928 stats enable
5929 stats hide-version
5930 stats scope .
5931 stats uri /admin?stats
5932 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5933 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5934 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5935
5936 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5937 backend private_monitoring
5938 stats enable
5939 stats uri /admin?stats
5940 stats refresh 5s
5941
5942 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5943
5944
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005945stats hide-version
5946 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5948 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005949 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005950
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005951 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5952 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5953 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5954 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5955 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5956 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005957
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005958 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5959 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5960 unobvious parameters.
5961
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005962 Example :
5963 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5964 backend public_www
5965 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005966 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005967 stats hide-version
5968 stats scope .
5969 stats uri /admin?stats
5970 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5971 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5972 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005973
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005974 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5975 backend private_monitoring
5976 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005977 stats uri /admin?stats
5978 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005979
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005980 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005981
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005982
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005983stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5984 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5985 Access control for statistics
5986
5987 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5988 no | no | yes | yes
5989
5990 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5991 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5992 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5993 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5994 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5995 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5996
5997 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5998 instance.
5999
6000 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6001 about ACL usage.
6002
6003
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006004stats realm <realm>
6005 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6007 yes | no | yes | yes
6008 Arguments :
6009 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6010 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6011 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6012
6013 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6014 using a backslash ('\').
6015
6016 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6017 only related to authentication.
6018
6019 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6020 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6021 unobvious parameters.
6022
6023 Example :
6024 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6025 backend public_www
6026 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6027 stats enable
6028 stats hide-version
6029 stats scope .
6030 stats uri /admin?stats
6031 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6032 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6033 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6034
6035 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6036 backend private_monitoring
6037 stats enable
6038 stats uri /admin?stats
6039 stats refresh 5s
6040
6041 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6042
6043
6044stats refresh <delay>
6045 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6047 yes | no | yes | yes
6048 Arguments :
6049 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6050 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6051 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6052 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6053 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6054 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6055
6056 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6057 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6058 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6059 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6060
6061 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6062 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6063 unobvious parameters.
6064
6065 Example :
6066 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6067 backend public_www
6068 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6069 stats enable
6070 stats hide-version
6071 stats scope .
6072 stats uri /admin?stats
6073 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6074 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6075 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6076
6077 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6078 backend private_monitoring
6079 stats enable
6080 stats uri /admin?stats
6081 stats refresh 5s
6082
6083 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6084
6085
6086stats scope { <name> | "." }
6087 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6089 yes | no | yes | yes
6090 Arguments :
6091 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6092 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6093 section in which the statement appears.
6094
6095 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6096 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6097 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6098 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6099 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6100 exists.
6101
6102 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6103 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6104 unobvious parameters.
6105
6106 Example :
6107 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6108 backend public_www
6109 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6110 stats enable
6111 stats hide-version
6112 stats scope .
6113 stats uri /admin?stats
6114 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6115 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6116 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6117
6118 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6119 backend private_monitoring
6120 stats enable
6121 stats uri /admin?stats
6122 stats refresh 5s
6123
6124 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6125
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006126
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006127stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006128 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6130 yes | no | yes | yes
6131
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006132 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006133 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6134
6135 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6136 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6137
6138 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6139 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006140 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006141
6142 Example :
6143 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6144 backend private_monitoring
6145 stats enable
6146 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6147 stats uri /admin?stats
6148 stats refresh 5s
6149
6150 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6151 global section.
6152
6153
6154stats show-legends
6155 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
6156 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6157 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6158 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6159 - IP (socket, server)
6160 - cookie (backend, server)
6161
6162 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6163 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006164 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006165
6166 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6167
6168
6169stats show-node [ <name> ]
6170 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6172 yes | no | yes | yes
6173 Arguments:
6174 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6175 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6176
6177 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6178 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006179 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006180
6181 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6182 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6183 unobvious parameters.
6184
6185 Example:
6186 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6187 backend private_monitoring
6188 stats enable
6189 stats show-node Europe-1
6190 stats uri /admin?stats
6191 stats refresh 5s
6192
6193 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6194 section.
6195
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006196
6197stats uri <prefix>
6198 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6200 yes | no | yes | yes
6201 Arguments :
6202 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6203 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6204 query string.
6205
6206 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6207 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6208 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6209 possible to reach it in the application.
6210
6211 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006212 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006213 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6214 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6215 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6216 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6217
6218 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6219 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6220 an address or a port to statistics only.
6221
6222 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6223 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6224 unobvious parameters.
6225
6226 Example :
6227 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6228 backend public_www
6229 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6230 stats enable
6231 stats hide-version
6232 stats scope .
6233 stats uri /admin?stats
6234 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6235 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6236 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6237
6238 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6239 backend private_monitoring
6240 stats enable
6241 stats uri /admin?stats
6242 stats refresh 5s
6243
6244 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6245
6246
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006247stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6248 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006250 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006251
6252 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006253 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006254 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6255 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6256 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6257
6258 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6259 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6260 the "stick-table" statement.
6261
6262 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6263 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6264 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6265 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6266 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6267
6268 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6269 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6270 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6271 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6272 transformation rules.
6273
6274 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6275 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6276 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6277 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6278 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6279 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6280 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6281
6282 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6283 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6284 ACL based conditions.
6285
6286 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6287 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6288 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6289 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6290
6291 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6292 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6293 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6294 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6295
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006296 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6297 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6298 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6299
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006300 Example :
6301 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6302 # last 30 minutes
6303 backend pop
6304 mode tcp
6305 balance roundrobin
6306 stick store-request src
6307 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6308 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6309 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6310
6311 backend smtp
6312 mode tcp
6313 balance roundrobin
6314 stick match src table pop
6315 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6316 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6317
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006318 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6319 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006320
6321
6322stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6323 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6325 no | no | yes | yes
6326
6327 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6328 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6329 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6330 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6331
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006332 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6333 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6334 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6335
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006336 Examples :
6337 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006338 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006339
6340 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6341 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6342 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6343
6344
6345 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6346 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6347 backend http
6348 mode http
6349 balance roundrobin
6350 stick on src table https
6351 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6352 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6353 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6354
6355 backend https
6356 mode tcp
6357 balance roundrobin
6358 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6359 stick on src
6360 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6361 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6362
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006363 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006364
6365
6366stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6367 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6369 no | no | yes | yes
6370
6371 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006372 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006373 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6374 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6375 server is selected.
6376
6377 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6378 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6379 the "stick-table" statement.
6380
6381 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6382 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6383 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6384 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6385 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6386 address.
6387
6388 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6389 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6390 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6391 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6392 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6393 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6394 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6395 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6396 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6397 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6398
6399 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6400 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6401 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6402 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6403 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6404 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6405 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6406
6407 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6408 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6409 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6410 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6411
6412 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6413 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6414 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6415 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6416 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6417 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006418 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6419 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6420 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6421 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6422 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6423 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006424
6425 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6426 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6427 the request.
6428
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006429 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6430 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6431 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6432
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006433 Example :
6434 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6435 # last 30 minutes
6436 backend pop
6437 mode tcp
6438 balance roundrobin
6439 stick store-request src
6440 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6441 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6442 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6443
6444 backend smtp
6445 mode tcp
6446 balance roundrobin
6447 stick match src table pop
6448 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6449 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6450
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006451 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6452 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006453
6454
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006455stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006456 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6457 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006458 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006460 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006461
6462 Arguments :
6463 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6464 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6465 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6466 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6467
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006468 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6469 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6470 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6471 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6472
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006473 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6474 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6475 instance.
6476
6477 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6478 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6479 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6480 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6481 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6482 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006483 to 32 characters.
6484
6485 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6486 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6487 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6488 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6489 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6490 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006491
6492 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006493 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6494 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006495 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6496 increase.
6497
6498 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006499 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6500 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6501 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006502
6503 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6504 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6505 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6506 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6507 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6508 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6509 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6510 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6511 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6512 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6513 parameter (see below).
6514
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006515 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6516 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6517 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6518 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6519 soft restart.
6520
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006521 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6522
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006523 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6524 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6525 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6526 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6527 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006528 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006529 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6530 if not expiration delay is specified.
6531
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006532 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6533 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6534 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6535 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006536 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6537 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6538 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6539 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6540 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6541 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6542 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6543 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6544 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6545 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6546 types and their arguments.
6547
6548 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6549 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6550 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6551 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6552
6553 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6554 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6555 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6556 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6557
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006558 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6559 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6560 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6561 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6562 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6563 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6564
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006565 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6566 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6567 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6568 they were received.
6569
6570 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6571 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6572 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6573 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6574 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6575
6576 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6577 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6578 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6579 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6580 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6581
6582 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6583 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6584 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6585
6586 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6587 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6588 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6589 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6590 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6591
6592 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6593 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6594 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6595 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6596 the client side.
6597
6598 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6599 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6600 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6601 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6602 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6603 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6604 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6605
6606 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6607 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6608 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6609 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6610 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6611 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6612 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6613
6614 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6615 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6616 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6617 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6618 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6619 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6620
6621 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6622 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6623 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6624 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6625
6626 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6627 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6628 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6629 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6630 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6631 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6632 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6633 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6634 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6635 recommended for better fairness.
6636
6637 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6638 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6639 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6640 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6641
6642 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6643 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6644 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6645 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6646 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6647 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6648 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6649 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6650 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6651 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006652
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006653 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6654 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006655 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6656 reference it.
6657
6658 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6659 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6660 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6661 as an exclusive stickiness.
6662
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006663 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6664 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6665 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6666 something that can be ignored.
6667
6668 Example:
6669 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6670 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6671 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6672 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6673
6674 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006675 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006676
6677
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006678stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6679 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6681 no | no | yes | yes
6682
6683 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006684 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006685 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6686 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6687 server is selected.
6688
6689 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6690 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6691 the "stick-table" statement.
6692
6693 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6694 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6695 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6696 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6697
6698 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6699 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6700 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6701 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6702 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6703 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006704 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006705 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6706 rules.
6707
6708 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6709 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6710 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6711 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6712 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6713 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6714 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6715
6716 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6717 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6718 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6719 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6720
6721 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6722 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6723 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6724 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6725 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6726 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006727 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
6728 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6729 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6730 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6731 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6732 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
6733 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
6734 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
6735 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006736
6737 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6738
6739 Example :
6740 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6741 backend https
6742 mode tcp
6743 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006744 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006745 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006746
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006747 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6748 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6749
6750 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6751 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6752 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6753
6754 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6755 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006756
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006757 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6758 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6759 # at offset 44.
6760
6761 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6762 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6763
6764 # Learn on response if server hello.
6765 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006766
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006767 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6768 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6769
6770 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6771 extraction.
6772
6773
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006774tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6775 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6777 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006778 Arguments :
6779 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006780 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6781 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006782
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006783 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006784
6785 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6786 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006787 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6788 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6789 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6790 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6791 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6792 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006793
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006794 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6795 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6796 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6797 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006798
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006799 Three types of actions are supported :
6800 - accept :
6801 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6802 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6803 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006804
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006805 - reject :
6806 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6807 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6808 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6809 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6810 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6811 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6812 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6813 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6814 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6815 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6816 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6817 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006818
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006819 - expect-proxy layer4 :
6820 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
6821 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
6822 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
6823 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
6824 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
6825 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
6826 hosts.
6827
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006828 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006829 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6830 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6831 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006832 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6833 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006834 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006835 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
6836 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
6837 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
6838 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
6839 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006840
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006841 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006842 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006843 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006844 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
6845 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
6846 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
6847 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006848
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006849 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6850 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6851 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6852 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006853
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006854 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6855 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6856 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6857 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6858 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006859 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
6860 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
6861 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
6862 layer7 information is extracted.
6863
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006864 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6865 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6866 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6867 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6868 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006869
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006870 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6871 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6872 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006873
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006874 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6875 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6876 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006877
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006878 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006879 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006880 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006881
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006882 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6883 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6884 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006885
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006886 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006887 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
6888 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006889
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006890 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
6891
6892 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
6893
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006894 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6895
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006896 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006897
6898
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006899tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6900 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006902 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006903 Arguments :
6904 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006905 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6906 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02006907 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006908
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006909 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006910
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006911 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6912 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6913 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6914 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6915 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006916
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006917 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6918 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6919 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6920 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6921 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6922 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6923 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6924 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6925 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006926
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006927 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6928 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6929 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6930 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006931
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006932 Three types of actions are supported :
6933 - accept :
6934 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006935 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006936
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006937 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6938 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006939
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006940 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6941 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6942 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006943 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. This makes a subtle
6944 difference because tracking rules in "frontend" and "listen" section last for
6945 all the session, as opposed to the backend rules. The difference appears when
6946 some layer 7 information is tracked. While there is nothing mandatory about
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006947 it, it is recommended to use the track-sc0 pointer to track per-frontend
6948 counters and track-sc1 to track per-backend counters, but this is just a
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02006949 guideline and all counters may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006950
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006951 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006952 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6953 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006954
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006955 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006956 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6957 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6958 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6959 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6960 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006961
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006962 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
6963 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
6964 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
6965 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
6966
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006967 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006968 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6969 # and reject everything else.
6970 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6971 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006972 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006973 tcp-request content reject
6974
6975 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006976 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6977 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6978 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006979 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006980
6981 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6982 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6983 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006984 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006985 tcp-request content reject
6986
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006987 Example:
6988 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
6989 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006990 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006991
6992 Example:
6993 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
6994 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006995 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006996
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006997 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6998 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6999
7000 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007001 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007002 # protecting all our sites
7003 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007004 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7005 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007006 ...
7007 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7008
7009 backend http_dynamic
7010 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007011 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007012 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007013 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7014 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7015 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007016 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007017
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007018 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007019
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007020 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007021
7022
7023tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7024 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007026 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007027 Arguments :
7028 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7029 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7030 as explained at the top of this document.
7031
7032 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7033 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7034 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7035 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7036 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7037
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007038 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7039 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7040 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7041 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7042
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007043 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7044 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007045 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007046 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007047 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7048 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7049 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7050 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007051
7052 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7053 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7054 it pass through unaffected.
7055
7056 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7057 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7058 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007059 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007060 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7061 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007062 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7063 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7064 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007065
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007066 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007067 "timeout client".
7068
7069
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007070tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7071 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7073 no | no | yes | yes
7074 Arguments :
7075 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007076 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007077
7078 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7079
7080 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7081 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7082 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007083 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7084 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007085
7086 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7087
7088 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7089 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7090 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7091 inserted.
7092
7093 Two types of actions are supported :
7094 - accept :
7095 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7096 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7097 the rules evaluation.
7098
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007099 - close :
7100 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7101 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7102 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7103 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7104 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7105 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
7106 connections which take signifiant resources on servers with certain
7107 protocols.
7108
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007109 - reject :
7110 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7111 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007112 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007113
7114 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7115 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7116 for changing the default action to a reject.
7117
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007118 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7119 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7120 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7121 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007122 period.
7123
7124 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7125
7126 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7127
7128
7129tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7130 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7132 no | no | yes | yes
7133 Arguments :
7134 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7135 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7136 as explained at the top of this document.
7137
7138 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7139
7140
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007141timeout check <timeout>
7142 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7143 established.
7144
7145 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7146 yes | no | yes | yes
7147 Arguments:
7148 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7149 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7150 as explained at the top of this document.
7151
7152 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7153 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7154 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7155 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007156 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7157 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7158 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007159
7160 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7161 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7162
7163 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7164 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007165 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007166
7167 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7168 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7169 forget about it.
7170
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007171 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7172 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007173
7174
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007175timeout client <timeout>
7176timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7177 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7179 yes | yes | yes | no
7180 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007181 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007182 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7183 as explained at the top of this document.
7184
7185 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7186 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7187 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7188 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7189 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7190 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7191 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7192 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007193 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007194 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007195 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7196 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
7197 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007198
7199 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7200 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7201 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7202 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7203 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7204 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7205
7206 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7207 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7208 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7209
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007210 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007211
7212
7213timeout connect <timeout>
7214timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7215 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7217 yes | no | yes | yes
7218 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007219 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007220 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7221 as explained at the top of this document.
7222
7223 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007224 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007225 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007226 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007227 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7228 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007229
7230 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7231 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7232 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7233 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7234 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7235 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7236
7237 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7238 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7239 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7240
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007241 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7242 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007243
7244
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007245timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7246 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7248 yes | yes | yes | yes
7249 Arguments :
7250 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7251 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7252 as explained at the top of this document.
7253
7254 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7255 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7256 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7257 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7258 once the request has started to present itself.
7259
7260 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7261 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7262 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7263 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7264 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7265
7266 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7267 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7268 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7269 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7270
7271 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7272 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7273 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7274 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7275 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007276 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007277
7278 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7279 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7280 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7281 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7282
7283 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7284
7285
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007286timeout http-request <timeout>
7287 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007289 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007290 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007291 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007292 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7293 as explained at the top of this document.
7294
7295 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7296 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7297 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7298 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7299 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7300 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7301 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
7302 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
7303
7304 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7305 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007306 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7307 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007308
7309 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7310 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7311 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7312 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7313 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7314
7315 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007316 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7317 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7318 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007319
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007320 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007321
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007322
7323timeout queue <timeout>
7324 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7326 yes | no | yes | yes
7327 Arguments :
7328 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7329 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7330 as explained at the top of this document.
7331
7332 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7333 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7334 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7335 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7336 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7337
7338 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7339 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7340 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7341 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7342
7343 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7344
7345
7346timeout server <timeout>
7347timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7348 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7350 yes | no | yes | yes
7351 Arguments :
7352 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7353 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7354 as explained at the top of this document.
7355
7356 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7357 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7358 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7359 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7360 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7361 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7362 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7363
7364 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7365 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7366 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7367 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7368 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007369 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007370 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007371 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7372 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7373 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7374 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007375
7376 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7377 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7378 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7379 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7380 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7381 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7382
7383 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7384 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7385 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7386
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007387 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007388
7389
7390timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007391 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7393 yes | yes | yes | yes
7394 Arguments :
7395 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7396 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7397 as explained at the top of this document.
7398
7399 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7400 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7401 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7402
7403 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7404 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7405 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7406 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007407 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007408
7409 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7410
7411
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007412timeout tunnel <timeout>
7413 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7415 yes | no | yes | yes
7416 Arguments :
7417 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7418 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7419 as explained at the top of this document.
7420
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007421 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007422 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7423 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7424 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7425 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7426 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7427 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7428 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7429 specified.
7430
7431 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7432 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7433 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7434 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7435 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7436
7437 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7438 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7439 forget about it.
7440
7441 Example :
7442 defaults http
7443 option http-server-close
7444 timeout connect 5s
7445 timeout client 30s
7446 timeout client 30s
7447 timeout server 30s
7448 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7449
7450 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
7451
7452
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007453transparent (deprecated)
7454 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007456 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007457 Arguments : none
7458
7459 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7460 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7461 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7462 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7463 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7464 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7465 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7466 appropriate server.
7467
7468 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7469
7470 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7471 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7472
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007473 See also: "option transparent"
7474
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007475unique-id-format <string>
7476 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7478 yes | yes | yes | no
7479 Arguments :
7480 <string> is a log-format string.
7481
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007482 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7483 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7484 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7485 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007486
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007487 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7488 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7489 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7490 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7491 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7492 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7493 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7494 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007495
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007496 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7497 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007498
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007499 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007500
7501 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7502
7503 will generate:
7504
7505 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7506
7507 See also: "unique-id-header"
7508
7509unique-id-header <name>
7510 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7512 yes | yes | yes | no
7513 Arguments :
7514 <name> is the name of the header.
7515
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007516 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7517 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007518
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007519 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007520
7521 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7522 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7523
7524 will generate:
7525
7526 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7527
7528 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007529
7530use_backend <backend> if <condition>
7531use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007532 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7534 no | yes | yes | no
7535 Arguments :
7536 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
7537
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007538 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007539
7540 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7541 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7542 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007543 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7544 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7545 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7546 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007547
7548 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7549 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7550 assign the backend.
7551
7552 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7553 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7554 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7555 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7556 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7557 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7558
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007559 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007560 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007561 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7562 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7563 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7564
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007565 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007566
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007567
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007568use-server <server> if <condition>
7569use-server <server> unless <condition>
7570 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
7571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7572 no | no | yes | yes
7573 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007574 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007575
7576 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
7577
7578 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
7579 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
7580 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
7581
7582 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
7583 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
7584 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
7585 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
7586 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
7587 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
7588 matches will assign the server.
7589
7590 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
7591 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
7592 with the next rules until one matches.
7593
7594 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7595 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7596 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7597 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7598
7599 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7600 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7601 stripped.
7602
7603 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7604 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7605 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7606 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7607
7608 Example :
7609 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7610 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7611 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7612 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7613 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7614 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7615 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7616 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7617 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7618
7619 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
7620
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007621
76225. Bind and Server options
7623--------------------------
7624
7625The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7626depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7627settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7628written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7629described in this section.
7630
7631
76325.1. Bind options
7633-----------------
7634
7635The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
7636as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
7637no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
7638parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
7639while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
7640provided immediately after the setting name.
7641
7642The currently supported settings are the following ones.
7643
7644accept-proxy
7645 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
7646 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
7647 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
7648 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
7649 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
7650 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
7651 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
7652 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
7653 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007654 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
7655 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007656
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007657alpn <protocols>
7658 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
7659 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
7660 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
7661 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
7662 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
7663 initial NPN extension.
7664
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007665backlog <backlog>
7666 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
7667 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
7668
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007669ecdhe <named curve>
7670 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01007671 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
7672 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007673
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007674ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007675 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7676 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7677 client's certificate.
7678
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007679ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7680 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7681 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7682 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7683 error is ignored.
7684
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007685ciphers <ciphers>
7686 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7687 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
7688 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
7689 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7690 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7691
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007692crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007693 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7694 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7695 to verify client's certificate.
7696
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007697crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007698 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7699 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
7700 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
7701 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
7702 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
7703 file.
7704
7705 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
7706 are loaded.
7707
7708 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
7709 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
7710 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
7711 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
7712 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
7713 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
7714 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
7715 www.sub.example.org).
7716
7717 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
7718 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
7719 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
7720 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
7721 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7722
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007723 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007724
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007725 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
7726 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
7727 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires a intermediate CA (for
7728 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
7729 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
7730 clients).
7731
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007732crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007733 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
7734 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
7735 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an error
7736 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007737
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007738crt-list <file>
7739 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007740 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
7741 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007742
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007743 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007744
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007745 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
7746 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
7747 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
7748 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
7749 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
7750 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
7751 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
7752 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007753
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007754defer-accept
7755 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7756 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7757 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7758 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7759 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
7760 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
7761 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
7762 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
7763 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
7764 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
7765 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7766
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007767force-sslv3
7768 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7769 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
7770 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7771
7772force-tlsv10
7773 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7774 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7775
7776force-tlsv11
7777 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7778 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7779
7780force-tlsv12
7781 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7782 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7783
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007784gid <gid>
7785 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7786 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7787 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7788 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7789 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7790
7791group <group>
7792 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
7793 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
7794 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
7795 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
7796 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7797
7798id <id>
7799 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
7800 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
7801 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
7802 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
7803
7804interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01007805 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
7806 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
7807 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
7808 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
7809 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
7810 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
7811 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007812
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02007813level <level>
7814 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
7815 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
7816 sockets. <level> can be one of :
7817 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
7818 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
7819 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
7820 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
7821 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
7822 counters).
7823 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
7824 all counters).
7825
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007826maxconn <maxconn>
7827 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
7828 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
7829 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
7830 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
7831 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
7832 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
7833 eat all memory.
7834
7835mode <mode>
7836 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
7837 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
7838 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
7839 UNIX sockets.
7840
7841mss <maxseg>
7842 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
7843 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
7844 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
7845 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
7846 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
7847 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
7848 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
7849 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
7850 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
7851 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
7852 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
7853
7854name <name>
7855 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
7856 page.
7857
7858nice <nice>
7859 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7860 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7861 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7862 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7863 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7864 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7865 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7866 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7867 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7868 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7869 one for an RDP socket.
7870
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007871no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007872 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7873 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7874 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007875 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7876 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007877
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007878no-tls-tickets
7879 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7880 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7881 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7882 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7883
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007884no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007885 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007886 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7887 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7888 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7889 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007890
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007891no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007892 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007893 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7894 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7895 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7896 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007897
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007898no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007899 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007900 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7901 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7902 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7903 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007904
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007905npn <protocols>
7906 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7907 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7908 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7909 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007910 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
7911 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007912
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007913ssl
7914 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7915 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7916 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7917 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7918 to deciphered contents.
7919
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01007920strict-sni
7921 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
7922 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
7923 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
7924 See the "crt" option for more information.
7925
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007926tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01007927 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007928 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7929 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7930 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7931 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7932 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7933 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7934 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02007935 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
7936 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
7937 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007938
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007939transparent
7940 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7941 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7942 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7943 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7944 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7945 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7946 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7947 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7948 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7949 so check for support with your vendor.
7950
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007951v4v6
7952 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7953 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
7954 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
7955 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
7956 sockets, and is overriden by the "v6only" option.
7957
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007958v6only
7959 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7960 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
7961 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007962 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
7963 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007964
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007965uid <uid>
7966 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7967 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7968 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7969 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7970 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7971
7972user <user>
7973 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7974 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7975 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7976 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7977 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7978
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007979verify [none|optional|required]
7980 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7981 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7982 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7983 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7984 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007985 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7986 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7987 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7988 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007989
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020079905.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007991------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007992
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007993The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7994which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7995arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7996settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7997after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7998Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7999address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008001 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008002 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008003
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008004The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008005
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008006addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008007 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8008 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8009 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8010 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8011 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008012
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008013 Supported in default-server: No
8014
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008015agent-check
8016 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
8017 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP
8018 connection to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter" and reading
8019 an ASCII string. The string should have one of the following forms:
8020
8021 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
8022 e.g. "75%"
8023
8024 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8025 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8026
8027 * The string "drain".
8028
8029 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
8030 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
8031 persistence.
8032
8033 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
8034
8035 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
8036
8037 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
8038
8039 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8040
8041 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
8042
8043 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8044
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008045 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8046 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
8047 parameter.
8048
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008049 Requires the ""agent-port" parameter to be set.
8050 See also the "agent-check" parameter.
8051
8052 Supported in default-server: No
8053
8054agent-inter <delay>
8055 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8056 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8057
8058 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8059 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8060 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8061 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8062 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8063 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8064 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8065 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8066 of backends use the same servers.
8067
8068 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8069
8070 Supported in default-server: Yes
8071
8072agent-port <port>
8073 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8074
8075 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8076
8077 Supported in default-server: Yes
8078
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008079backup
8080 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8081 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8082 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8083 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8084 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8085 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008086
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008087 Supported in default-server: No
8088
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008089ca-file <cafile>
8090 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8091 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8092 server's certificate.
8093
8094 Supported in default-server: No
8095
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008096check
8097 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008098 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8099 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8100 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8101 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8102 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8103 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8104 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008105 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8106 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8107 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008108
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008109 Supported in default-server: No
8110
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008111check-send-proxy
8112 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8113 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8114 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8115 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8116 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8117 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8118 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8119
8120 Supported in default-server: No
8121
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008122check-ssl
8123 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8124 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8125 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8126 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
8127 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
8128 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8129 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8130 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8131 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8132
8133 Supported in default-server: No
8134
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008135ciphers <ciphers>
8136 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
8137 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
8138 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8139 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8140 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8141 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8142 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8143 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8144
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008145 Supported in default-server: No
8146
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008147cookie <value>
8148 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8149 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8150 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8151 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8152 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8153 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8154 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8155
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008156 Supported in default-server: No
8157
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008158crl-file <crlfile>
8159 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8160 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8161 to verify server's certificate.
8162
8163 Supported in default-server: No
8164
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008165crt <cert>
8166 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8167 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8168 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8169 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8170 certificate request.
8171
8172 Supported in default-server: No
8173
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008174disabled
8175 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8176 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8177 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8178 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8179 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8180
8181 Supported in default-server: No
8182
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008183error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008184 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8185 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8186 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008187
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008188 Supported in default-server: Yes
8189
8190 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008191
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008192fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008193 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8194 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8195 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8196
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008197 Supported in default-server: Yes
8198
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008199force-sslv3
8200 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8201 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8202 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8203
8204 Supported in default-server: No
8205
8206force-tlsv10
8207 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8208 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8209
8210 Supported in default-server: No
8211
8212force-tlsv11
8213 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8214 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8215
8216 Supported in default-server: No
8217
8218force-tlsv12
8219 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8220 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8221
8222 Supported in default-server: No
8223
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008224id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008225 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8226 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8227 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008228
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008229 Supported in default-server: No
8230
8231inter <delay>
8232fastinter <delay>
8233downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008234 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8235 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8236 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8237 between checks depending on the server state :
8238
8239 Server state | Interval used
8240 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8241 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8242 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8243 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8244 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8245 or yet unchecked. |
8246 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8247 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8248 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008249
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008250 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8251 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8252 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8253 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008254 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8255 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8256 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8257 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8258 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008259
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008260 Supported in default-server: Yes
8261
8262maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008263 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8264 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8265 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8266 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8267 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8268 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8269 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8270 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8271
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008272 Supported in default-server: Yes
8273
8274maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008275 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8276 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8277 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8278 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8279 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8280 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8281 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008283 Supported in default-server: Yes
8284
8285minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008286 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8287 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8288 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8289 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8290 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8291 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008292 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008293 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008294
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008295 Supported in default-server: Yes
8296
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008297no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008298 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8299 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008300 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008301
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008302 Supported in default-server: No
8303
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008304no-tls-tickets
8305 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8306 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8307 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8308 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8309
8310 Supported in default-server: No
8311
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008312no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008313 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008314 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8315 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008316 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8317 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008318
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008319 Supported in default-server: No
8320
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008321no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008322 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008323 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8324 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008325 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8326 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008327
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008328 Supported in default-server: No
8329
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008330no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008331 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008332 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8333 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008334 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8335 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008336
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008337 Supported in default-server: No
8338
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008339non-stick
8340 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8341 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8342 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8343
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008344 Supported in default-server: No
8345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008346observe <mode>
8347 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8348 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8349 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8350 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8351 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8352 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008353 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008354
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008355 Supported in default-server: No
8356
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008357 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
8358
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008359on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008360 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
8361 Currently, four modes are available:
8362 - fastinter: force fastinter
8363 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
8364 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
8365 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8366 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
8367
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008368 Supported in default-server: Yes
8369
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008370 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
8371
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008372on-marked-down <action>
8373 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8374 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008375 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8376 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8377 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8378 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8379 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8380 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8381 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8382 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008383
8384 Actions are disabled by default
8385
8386 Supported in default-server: Yes
8387
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008388on-marked-up <action>
8389 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8390 Currently one action is available:
8391 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8392 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8393 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8394 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8395 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8396 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8397 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8398 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8399
8400 Actions are disabled by default
8401
8402 Supported in default-server: Yes
8403
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008404port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008405 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8406 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8407 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8408 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8409 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8410 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8411
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008412 Supported in default-server: Yes
8413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008414redir <prefix>
8415 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8416 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8417 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8418 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8419 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8420 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8421 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8422 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008423 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008424 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8425 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8426 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8427 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8428 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8429
8430 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8431
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008432 Supported in default-server: No
8433
8434rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008435 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8436 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8437 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8438
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008439 Supported in default-server: Yes
8440
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008441send-proxy
8442 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8443 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8444 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8445 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8446 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8447 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8448 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8449 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8450 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008451 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8452 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8453 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8454 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8455 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008456
8457 Supported in default-server: No
8458
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008459slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008460 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8461 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8462 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8463 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8464 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8465 parameters :
8466
8467 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8468 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8469
8470 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8471 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8472 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8473 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8474
8475 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8476 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8477 seen as failed.
8478
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008479 Supported in default-server: Yes
8480
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008481source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008482source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008483source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008484 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8485 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
8486 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
8487 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
8488
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008489 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
8490 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
8491 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
8492 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
8493 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
8494 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
8495 server.
8496
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008497 Supported in default-server: No
8498
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008499ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008500 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
8501 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
8502 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
8503 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
8504 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
8505 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
8506 See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008507
8508 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008510track [<proxy>/]<server>
8511 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
8512 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
8513 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
8514 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
8515 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
8516
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008517 Supported in default-server: No
8518
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008519verify [none|required]
8520 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8521 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
8522 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
8523 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008524 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
8525 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
8526 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008527
8528 Supported in default-server: No
8529
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07008530verifyhost <hostname>
8531 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
8532 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
8533 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
8534 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
8535 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
8536 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
8537
8538 Supported in default-server: No
8539
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008540weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008541 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
8542 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
8543 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02008544 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
8545 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
8546 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
8547 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
8548 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
8549 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008550
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008551 Supported in default-server: Yes
8552
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008553
85546. HTTP header manipulation
8555---------------------------
8556
8557In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
8558response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
8559request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
8560which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
8561against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
8562to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
8563passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
8564headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
8565never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
8566
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008567There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
8568(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
8569rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
8570messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
8571in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008572happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008573add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
8574normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
8575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008576This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
8577in section 4.2 :
8578
8579 - reqadd <string>
8580 - reqallow <search>
8581 - reqiallow <search>
8582 - reqdel <search>
8583 - reqidel <search>
8584 - reqdeny <search>
8585 - reqideny <search>
8586 - reqpass <search>
8587 - reqipass <search>
8588 - reqrep <search> <replace>
8589 - reqirep <search> <replace>
8590 - reqtarpit <search>
8591 - reqitarpit <search>
8592 - rspadd <string>
8593 - rspdel <search>
8594 - rspidel <search>
8595 - rspdeny <search>
8596 - rspideny <search>
8597 - rsprep <search> <replace>
8598 - rspirep <search> <replace>
8599
8600With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
8601is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
8602parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
8603prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
8604Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
8605
8606 \t for a tab
8607 \r for a carriage return (CR)
8608 \n for a new line (LF)
8609 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
8610 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
8611 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
8612 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
8613 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
8614
8615The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
8616portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
8617above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
8618regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
86199 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
8620is very common to users of the "sed" program.
8621
8622The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
8623after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
8624
8625Notes related to these keywords :
8626---------------------------------
8627 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
8628 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
8629 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
8630
8631 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
8632 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
8633 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
8634
8635 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
8636 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
8637 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
8638 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
8639 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
8640
8641 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
8642 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
8643 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
8644 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
8645 useless headers before adding new ones.
8646
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008647 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008648 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
8649
8650 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
8651 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
8652 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
8653
8654 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
8655 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008656 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008657
8658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020086597. Using ACLs and fetching samples
8660----------------------------------
8661
8662Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
8663client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
8664The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
8665these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
8666but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
8667data called patterns.
8668
8669
86707.1. ACL basics
8671---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008672
8673The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
8674content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
8675from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
8676simple :
8677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008678 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008679 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008680 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
8681 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008683The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
8684adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008685
8686In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
8687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008688 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008689
8690This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
8691Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
8692and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008693an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
8694conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
8695as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
8696are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008697
8698ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
8699'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
8700which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
8701
8702There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
8703performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
8704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008705The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
8706specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
8707this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008708methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
8709ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008710
8711Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
8712 - boolean
8713 - integer (signed or unsigned)
8714 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
8715 - string
8716 - data block
8717
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008718Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
8719converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
8720would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
8721The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
8722which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
8723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008724The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
8725 - boolean
8726 - integer or integer range
8727 - IP address / network
8728 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
8729 - regular expression
8730 - hex block
8731
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008732The following ACL flags are currently supported :
8733
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008734 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
8735 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008736 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008737 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
8738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008739The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
8740read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
8741if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
8742lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
8743will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
8744beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
8745a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
8746lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
8747exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
8748
8749Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
8750loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
8751
8752 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
8753
8754In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
8755the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
8756case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
8757as well.
8758
8759The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
8760sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
8761do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
8762methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
8763is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
8764obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
8765followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
8766default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
8767that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
8768string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
8769
8770There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
8771sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
8772be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008773
8774 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
8775 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008776 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
8777 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
8778 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
8779 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008780
8781 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
8782 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008783 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008784
8785 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008786 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008787
8788 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008789 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008790
8791 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
8792 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
8793
8794 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
8795 binary or string samples.
8796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008797 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
8798 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008800 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
8801 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
8802 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008804 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
8805 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008807 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
8808 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008810 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
8811 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008813 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
8814 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008815 This may be used with binary or string samples.
8816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008817 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
8818 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
8819 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008820
8821For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
8822request, it is possible to do :
8823
8824 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
8825
8826In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
8827buffer, one would use the following acl :
8828
8829 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
8830
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008831On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
8832possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
8833
8834 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
8835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008836All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
8837criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
8838method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
8839to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
8840criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
8841the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008843If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
8844the mathing method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method. For
8845example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008847 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
8848 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
8849 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
8850 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008851
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008852
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008853The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample types
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008854and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
8855combination the name of the matching method to be used, prefixed with "*" when
8856the method is implicit and will work by default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008858 +-------------------------------------------------+
8859 | Input sample type |
8860 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8861 | pattern type | boolean | integer | IP | string | binary |
8862 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8863 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
8864 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008865 | none (boolean value) | *bool | bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008866 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008867 | integer (value) | int | *int | int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008868 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008869 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008870 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008871 | IP address | | | *ip | ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008872 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008873 | exact string | str | str | str | str | str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008874 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008875 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008876 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008877 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008878 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008879 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008880 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008881 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008882 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008883 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008884 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008885 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008886 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8887 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
8888 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008889
8890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020088917.1.1. Matching booleans
8892------------------------
8893
8894In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
8895Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
8896When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
8897that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
8898
8899Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
8900return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
8901"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
8902
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020089047.1.2. Matching integers
8905------------------------
8906
8907Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
8908enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
8909to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
8910
8911Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
8912matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
8913lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008914
8915For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
8916unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
8917representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
8918
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008919As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
8920two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
8921instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
8922ranges and operators.
8923
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008924For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008925operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
8926Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
8927of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008928
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008929Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008930
8931 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
8932 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
8933 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
8934 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
8935 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
8936
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008937For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008938
8939 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
8940
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008941This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
8942
8943 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
8944
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020089467.1.3. Matching strings
8947-----------------------
8948
8949String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
8950different forms :
8951
8952 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
8953 patterns ;
8954
8955 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
8956 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
8957
8958 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
8959 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
8960
8961 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
8962 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
8963
8964 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
8965 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
8966 matches.
8967
8968 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
8969 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
8970 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008971
8972String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
8973exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
8974characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
8975string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
8976to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008977before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008978
8979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020089807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
8981---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008982
8983Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
8984they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
8985possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
8986passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
8987the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008988the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
8989match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008990
8991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020089927.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
8993-------------------------------------
8994
8995It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
8996not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
8997a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
8998to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
8999digits may be used upper or lower case.
9000
9001Example :
9002 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9003 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9004
9005
90067.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9007---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009008
9009IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9010netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9011within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009012host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009013difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9014at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9015does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9016parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009017
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009018IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9019Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9020trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9021IPv6 patterns.
9022
9023HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9024following situations :
9025 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9026 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9027 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9028 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9029 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9030 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9031 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9032 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9033 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9034 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009036
90377.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9038----------------------------------
9039
9040Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9041combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9042
9043 - AND (implicit)
9044 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9045 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009047A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009049 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009051Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9052indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009054For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9055"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9056requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9057is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9058
9059 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9060 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9061 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9062 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9063
9064To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9065and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9066
9067 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9068 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9069 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9070 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9071
9072 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9073 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9074 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9075 use_backend www if host_www
9076
9077It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9078expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9079be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9080the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9081
9082 The following rule :
9083
9084 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9085 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9086
9087 Can also be written that way :
9088
9089 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9090
9091It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9092to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9093simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9094sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9095good use is the following :
9096
9097 With named ACLs :
9098
9099 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9100 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9101 monitor fail if site_dead
9102
9103 With anonymous ACLs :
9104
9105 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9106
9107See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9108
9109
91107.3. Fetching samples
9111---------------------
9112
9113Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9114against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9115sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9116ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9117of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9118available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9119
9120This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9121Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9122compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9123deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9124
9125The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9126matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9127method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9128indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9129
9130As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9131when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9132mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9133the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9134ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9135
9136Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9137multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9138when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9139incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9140are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9141is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9142all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9143
9144Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9145 - name
9146 - name(arg1)
9147 - name(arg1,arg2)
9148
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009149Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9150of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9151is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9152was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9153has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9154unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9155
9156These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9157sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9158the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9159support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009161The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009163 lower Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed
9164 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
9165 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009167 upper Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed
9168 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
9169 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009171 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for
9172 lookups and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within
9173 a certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9174 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9175 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9176
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009177 http_date([<offset>])
9178 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to
9179 a string representing this date in a format suitable for use
9180 in HTTP header fields. If an offset value is specified, then
9181 it is a number of seconds that is added to the date before the
9182 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit
9183 Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined
9184 with a positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the
9185 offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009186
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009187 map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9188 map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9189 map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9190 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type>
9191 matching method, and return the associated value converted to
9192 the type <output_type>. If the input value cannot be found in
9193 the <map_file>, the converter returns the <default_value>. If
9194 the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and acts
9195 as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is
9196 not set, it defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type>
9197 is not set, it defaults to "str". For convenience, the "map"
9198 keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a string to another
9199 string. The following array contains contains the list of all
9200 the map* converters.
9201
9202 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP
9203 addresses and strings are stored in trees, so the first of the
9204 finest match will be used. Other keys are stored in lists, so
9205 the first matching occurrence will be used.
9206
9207 +----+----------+---------+-------------+------------+
9208 | `-_ out | | | |
9209 | input `-_ | str | int | ip |
9210 | / match `-_ | | | |
9211 +---------------+---------+-------------+------------+
9212 | str / str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip |
9213 | str / sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip |
9214 | str / dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip |
9215 | str / dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip |
9216 | str / end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip |
9217 | str / reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip |
9218 | int / int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip |
9219 | ip / ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip |
9220 +---------------+---------+-------------+------------+
9221
9222 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start
9223 with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and
9224 spaces are stripped. The key is then the first "word" (series
9225 of non-space/tabs characters), and the value is what follows
9226 this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
9227 trailing spaces/tabs.
9228
9229 Example :
9230
9231 # this is a comment and is ignored
9232 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
9233 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
9234 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
9235 | | | `----------- value
9236 | | `--------------------- middle spaces ignored
9237 | `---------------------------- key
9238 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
9239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020092407.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
9241--------------------------------------------
9242
9243A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
9244not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
9245"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
9246The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
9247
9248always_false : boolean
9249 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9250 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9251
9252always_true : boolean
9253 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9254 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9255
9256avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009257 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009258 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
9259 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
9260 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
9261 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
9262 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
9263 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
9264 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
9265 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
9266 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
9267 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
9268 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
9269 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
9270 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01009271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009272be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009273 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
9274 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
9275 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
9276 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
9277 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009279be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
9280 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9281 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9282 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
9283 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
9284 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
9285 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009286
9287 Example :
9288 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
9289 backend dynamic
9290 mode http
9291 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
9292 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009294connslots([<backend>]) : integer
9295 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
9296 still available in the backend, by totalizing the maximum amount of
9297 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
9298 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05009299
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009300 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009301 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009302 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
9303
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009304 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
9305 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009306
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009307 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009308 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009309 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009310 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
9311 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009312 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009313 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009314
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009315 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
9316 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009317 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009318 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009319
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009320date([<offset>]) : integer
9321 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
9322 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
9323 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
9324 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009325 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
9326
9327 Example :
9328
9329 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
9330 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009331
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02009332env(<name>) : string
9333 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
9334 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
9335 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
9336 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
9337 certain way.
9338
9339 Examples :
9340 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
9341 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
9342
9343 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
9344 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
9345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009346fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
9347 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009348 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
9349 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009350 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
9351 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
9352 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
9353 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
9354 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009356fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
9357 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9358 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9359 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
9360 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
9361 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
9362 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
9363 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
9364 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009365
9366 Example :
9367 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
9368 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
9369 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
9370 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
9371 frontend mail
9372 bind :25
9373 mode tcp
9374 maxconn 100
9375 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
9376 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
9377 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
9378 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009380nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
9381 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
9382 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
9383 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009384 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
9385 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
9386 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009388queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009389 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
9390 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
9391 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009392 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
9393 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
9394 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
9395 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
9396 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
9397
9398srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9399 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9400 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
9401 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
9402 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
9403 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
9404 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
9405 methods.
9406
9407srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
9408 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
9409 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
9410 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
9411 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
9412 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
9413 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
9414 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
9415
9416srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9417 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9418 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
9419 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mosly
9420 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
9421 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
9422 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
9423 overloading servers).
9424
9425 Example :
9426 # Redirect to a separate back
9427 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
9428 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
9429 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
9430
9431table_avl([<table>]) : integer
9432 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
9433 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
9434
9435table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9436 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
9437 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
9438 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
9439
9440
94417.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
9442----------------------------------
9443
9444The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
9445closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
9446methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
9447sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
9448TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009449the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
9450counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
9451"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009452argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
9453the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
9454this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009455
9456be_id : integer
9457 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
9458 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
9459
9460dst : ip
9461 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
9462 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
9463 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9464 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
9465 RFC 4291.
9466
9467dst_conn : integer
9468 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9469 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
9470 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
9471 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
9472 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
9473 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
9474 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
9475 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009477dst_port : integer
9478 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
9479 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
9480 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
9481 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
9482 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
9483 an HTTP header.
9484
9485fe_id : integer
9486 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
9487 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
9488 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
9489
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009490sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9491sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9492sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9493sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009494 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
9495 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9496 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
9497
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009498sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9499sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9500sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9501sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009502 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
9503 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9504 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
9505
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009506sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9507sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9508sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9509sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009510 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
9511 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009512 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
9513 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
9514 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009515
9516 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9517 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009518 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9519 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
9520 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009521 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9522 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9523
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009524sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9525sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9526sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9527sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009528 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
9529 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
9530
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009531sc_conn_cur(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9532sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9533sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9534sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009535 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9536 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
9537 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
9538
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009539sc_conn_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9540sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9541sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9542sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009543 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
9544 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
9545 See also src_conn_rate.
9546
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009547sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9548sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9549sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9550sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009551 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009552 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009553
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009554sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9555sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9556sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9557sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009558 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9559 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
9560 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009561 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9562 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9563 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009564
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009565sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9566sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9567sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9568sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009569 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
9570 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
9571 See also src_http_err_cnt.
9572
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009573sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9574sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9575sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9576sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009577 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
9578 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9579 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
9580 src_http_err_rate.
9581
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009582sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9583sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9584sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9585sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009586 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9587 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9588 src_http_req_cnt.
9589
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009590sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9591sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9592sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9593sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009594 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9595 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
9596 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9597 src_http_req_rate.
9598
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009599sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9600sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9601sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9602sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009603 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009604 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
9605 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
9606 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
9607 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009608
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009609 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9610 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009611 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9612
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009613sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9614sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9615sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9616sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009617 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
9618 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9619 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9620 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
9621
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009622sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9623sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9624sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9625sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009626 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
9627 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9628 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9629 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
9630
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009631sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9632sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9633sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9634sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009635 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
9636 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
9637 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
9638 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009639 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009640 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
9641
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009642sc_sess_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9643sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9644sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9645sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009646 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
9647 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9648 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
9649 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
9650 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009651 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009652
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009653sc_tracked(<ctr>,[<table>]) : boolean
9654sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9655sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9656sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +02009657 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
9658 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
9659 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
9660
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009661sc_trackers(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9662sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9663sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9664sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009665 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9666 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009667 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009668 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
9669 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009670 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
9671 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
9672 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009674so_id : integer
9675 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
9676 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
9677 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009679src : ip
9680 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
9681 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
9682 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
9683 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
9684 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
9685 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
9686 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009687
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009688 Example:
9689 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
9690 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
9691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009692src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9693 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
9694 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
9695 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009696 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009698src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9699 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
9700 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009701 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009702 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009704src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9705 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9706 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9707 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
9708 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
9709 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
9710 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009711
9712 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9713 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
9714 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
9715 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009716 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009717 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9718 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009720src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009721 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009722 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009723 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009724 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009726src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009727 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009728 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
9729 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009730 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009732src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9733 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
9734 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9735 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009736 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009738src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009739 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009740 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009741 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009742 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009744src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009745 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009746 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009747 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
9748 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009749 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9750 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9751 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009753src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9754 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
9755 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009756 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009757 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009758 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009760src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9761 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
9762 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9763 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9764 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009765 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009767src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9768 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9769 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9770 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009771 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009773src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9774 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9775 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9776 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009777 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009778 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009780src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9781 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9782 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9783 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009784 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009785 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
9786 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009787
9788 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009789 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009790 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009792src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9793 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
9794 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9795 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
9796 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009797 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
9798 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009800src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9801 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
9802 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009803 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
9804 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009805 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009807src_port : integer
9808 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
9809 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
9810 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
9811 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009813src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9814 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009815 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9816 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
9817 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009818 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009820src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9821 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
9822 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9823 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9824 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009825 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009827src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9828 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
9829 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
9830 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
9831 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
9832 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
9833 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
9834 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
9835 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009836
9837 Example :
9838 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
9839 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
9840 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
9841 listen ssh
9842 bind :22
9843 mode tcp
9844 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009845 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009846 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009847 server local 127.0.0.1:22
9848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009849srv_id : integer
9850 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
9851 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
9852 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02009853
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01009854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098557.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
9856----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02009857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009858The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
9859closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
9860when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
9861usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
9862future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negociations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009864ssl_c_ca_err : integer
9865 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9866 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
9867 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
9868 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
9869 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009871ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
9872 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9873 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
9874 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
9875 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009877ssl_c_err : integer
9878 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9879 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
9880 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
9881 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
9882 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009884ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9885 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9886 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9887 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9888 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9889 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9890 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9891 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9892 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009894 ACL derivatives :
9895 ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009897ssl_c_key_alg : string
9898 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9899 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9900 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009902 ACL derivatives :
9903 ssl_c_key_alg : exact string match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009905ssl_c_notafter : string
9906 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
9907 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9908 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009910 ACL derivatives :
9911 ssl_c_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009913ssl_c_notbefore : string
9914 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
9915 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9916 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009918 ACL derivatives :
9919 ssl_c_notbefore : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009921ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9922 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9923 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
9924 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9925 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9926 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9927 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9928 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9929 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009931 ACL derivatives :
9932 ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009934ssl_c_serial : binary
9935 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
9936 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
9937 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009939 ACL derivatives :
9940 ssl_c_serial : hex block match
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009942ssl_c_sha1 : binary
9943 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
9944 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
9945 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009947ssl_c_sig_alg : string
9948 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
9949 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9950 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009952 ACL derivatives :
9953 ssl_c_sig_alg : exact string match
9954
9955ssl_c_used : boolean
9956 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
9957 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009959ssl_c_verify : integer
9960 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
9961 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
9962 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
9963 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009965ssl_c_version : integer
9966 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
9967 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009969ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9970 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9971 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9972 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9973 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009974 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009975 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9976 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9977 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009979 ACL derivatives :
9980 ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009982ssl_f_key_alg : string
9983 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9984 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
9985 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009987 ACL derivatives :
9988 ssl_f_key_alg : exact string match
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009990ssl_f_notafter : string
9991 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
9992 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9993 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009995 ACL derivatives :
9996 ssl_f_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009998ssl_f_notbefore : string
9999 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10000 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10001 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010003 ACL derivatives :
10004 ssl_f_notbefore : exact string match
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010006ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10007 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10008 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10009 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10010 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10011 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10012 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10013 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10014 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010016 ACL derivatives :
10017 ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010019ssl_f_serial : binary
10020 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10021 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10022 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010024 ACL derivatives :
10025 ssl_f_serial : hex block match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +020010026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010027ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10028 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10029 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10030 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010032 ACL derivatives :
10033 ssl_f_sig_alg : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +020010034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010035ssl_f_version : integer
10036 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10037 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10038
10039ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010040 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10041 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10042 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010044 Example :
10045 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10046 listen http-https
10047 bind :80
10048 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10049 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10050
10051ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10052 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10053 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10054
10055ssl_fc_alpn : string
10056 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negociation field from an
10057 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10058 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10059 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10060 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10061 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10062 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10063 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10064 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10065
10066 ACL derivatives :
10067 ssl_fc_alpn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010069ssl_fc_cipher : string
10070 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10071 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010073 ACL derivatives :
10074 ssl_fc_cipher : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010076ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010077 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10078 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010079 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10080 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10081 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10082 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010084ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10085 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010086 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10087 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10088 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10089 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010091ssl_fc_npn : string
10092 This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an incoming connection
10093 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10094 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10095 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10096 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10097 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10098 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10099 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010101 ACL derivatives :
10102 ssl_fc_npn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010104ssl_fc_protocol : string
10105 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10106 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010108 ACL derivatives :
10109 ssl_fc_protocol : exact string match
10110
10111ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10112 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10113 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10114 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10115 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010117ssl_fc_sni : string
10118 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10119 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10120 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10121 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10122 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10123
10124 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10125 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10126 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010127 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10128 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010130 ACL derivatives :
10131 ssl_fc_sni : exact string match
10132 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10133 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010135ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10136 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10137 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010138
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200101407.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
10141------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010143Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10144sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10145only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10146For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10147be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10148can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10149sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10150for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10151content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010153payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10154 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10155 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10156 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010158payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10159 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10160 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10161 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010163req.len : integer
10164req_len : integer (deprecated)
10165 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10166 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10167 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10168 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10169 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10170 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10171 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10172 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010174req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10175 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010176 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10177 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10178 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10179 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010181 ACL alternatives :
10182 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010184req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10185 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10186 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10187 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10188 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010190 ACL alternatives :
10191 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010193 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010195req.proto_http : boolean
10196req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10197 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10198 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10199 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10200 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
10201 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
10202 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
10203 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010205 Example:
10206 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10207 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10208 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010209 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010211req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
10212rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10213 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
10214 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
10215 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
10216 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
10217 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
10218 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
10219 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010221 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
10222 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
10223 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
10224 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
10225 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
10226 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010228 ACL derivatives :
10229 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010231 Example :
10232 listen tse-farm
10233 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
10234 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10235 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10236 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10237 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10238 persist rdp-cookie
10239 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
10240 # This is only useful makes sense if
10241 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
10242 stick-table type string size 204800
10243 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
10244 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10245 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010247 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
10248 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010250req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
10251rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
10252 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
10253 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
10254 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
10255 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010257 ACL derivatives :
10258 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010260req.ssl_hello_type : integer
10261req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10262 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10263 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
10264 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10265 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10266 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
10267 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10268 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010270req.ssl_sni : string
10271req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
10272 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
10273 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
10274 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
10275 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10276 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10277 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
10278 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
10279 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
10280 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
10281 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
10282 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
10283 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010285 ACL derivatives :
10286 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010288 Examples :
10289 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
10290 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10291 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
10292 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
10293 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010295res.ssl_hello_type : integer
10296rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10297 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10298 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
10299 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10300 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10301 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
10302 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10303 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020010304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010305req.ssl_ver : integer
10306req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
10307 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
10308 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
10309 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
10310 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
10311 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10312 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10313 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
10314 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
10315 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010317 ACL derivatives :
10318 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010319
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020010320res.len : integer
10321 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10322 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10323 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10324 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10325 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10326 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10327 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
10328 content inspection.
10329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010330res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10331 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010332 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10333 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10334 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10335 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010337res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10338 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10339 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10340 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
10341 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010343 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010345wait_end : boolean
10346 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
10347 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
10348 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
10349 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
10350 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
10351 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
10352 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
10353 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010355 Examples :
10356 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
10357 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
10358 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010360 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
10361 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10362 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
10363 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
10364 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
10365 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
10366 tcp-request content reject
10367
10368
103697.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
10370--------------------------------------
10371
10372It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
10373This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
10374data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
10375its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
10376HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
10377content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
10378to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
10379more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
10380response are indexed.
10381
10382base : string
10383 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
10384 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
10385 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
10386 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
10387 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
10388 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
10389 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
10390 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
10391
10392 ACL derivatives :
10393 base : exact string match
10394 base_beg : prefix match
10395 base_dir : subdir match
10396 base_dom : domain match
10397 base_end : suffix match
10398 base_len : length match
10399 base_reg : regex match
10400 base_sub : substring match
10401
10402base32 : integer
10403 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
10404 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
10405 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
10406 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
10407
10408base32+src : binary
10409 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
10410 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
10411 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
10412 per-URL counters.
10413
10414req.cook([<name>]) : string
10415cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10416 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10417 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10418 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
10419 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
10420 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
10421 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
10422 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
10423 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
10424
10425 ACL derivatives :
10426 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
10427 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
10428 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
10429 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
10430 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
10431 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
10432 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
10433 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010435req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10436cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10437 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10438 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010440req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10441cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10442 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10443 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
10444 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
10445 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010447cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10448 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10449 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
10450 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
10451 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
10452 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
10453 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
10454 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
10455 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
10456 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
10457 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010459hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10460 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
10461 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
10462 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
10463 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
10464 unambiguouslly apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010466req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
10467 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10468 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10469 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10470 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10471 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10472 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
10473 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
10474 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010476req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10477 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10478 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10479 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10480 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010482req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10483 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10484 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10485 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10486 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10487 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10488 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
10489 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
10490 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
10491 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
10492 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
10493 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010495 ACL derivatives :
10496 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10497 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10498 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10499 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10500 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10501 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10502 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10503 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10504
10505req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10506hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
10507 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10508 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
10509 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
10510 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
10511 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
10512 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
10513 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
10514 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
10515 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
10516
10517req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10518hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10519 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
10520 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
10521 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
10522 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10523 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10524 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10525 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
10526 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
10527
10528req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10529hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10530 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
10531 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
10532 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
10533 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10534 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10535 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10536 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
10537
10538http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
10539 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10540 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
10541 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10542 basic auth is supported.
10543
10544http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group
10545 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10546 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist, and
10547 whether that username belongs to one of the groups supplied in ACL patterns.
10548 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10549 basic auth is supported.
10550
10551 ACL derivatives :
10552 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : user group match
10553
10554http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010555 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
10556 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010557 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
10558 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010560method : integer + string
10561 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
10562 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
10563 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
10564 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
10565 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
10566 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
10567 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010569 ACL derivatives :
10570 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010572 Example :
10573 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
10574 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
10575 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010577path : string
10578 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
10579 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
10580 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
10581 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
10582 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
10583 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
10584 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010586 ACL derivatives :
10587 path : exact string match
10588 path_beg : prefix match
10589 path_dir : subdir match
10590 path_dom : domain match
10591 path_end : suffix match
10592 path_len : length match
10593 path_reg : regex match
10594 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010596req.ver : string
10597req_ver : string (deprecated)
10598 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
10599 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
10600 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010602 ACL derivatives :
10603 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010605res.comp : boolean
10606 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
10607 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
10608 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010610res.comp_algo : string
10611 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
10612 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
10613 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010615res.cook([<name>]) : string
10616scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10617 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10618 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10619 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010621 ACL derivatives :
10622 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010624res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10625scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10626 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10627 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
10628 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010630res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10631scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10632 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10633 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
10634 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010636res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10637 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10638 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10639 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10640 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10641 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
10642 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
10643 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
10644 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
10645 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010647res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10648 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10649 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10650 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10651 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
10652 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010654res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10655shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
10656 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10657 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10658 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10659 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10660 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
10661 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
10662 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
10663 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010665 ACL derivatives :
10666 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10667 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10668 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10669 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10670 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10671 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10672 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10673 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10674
10675res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10676shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10677 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10678 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10679 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
10680 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
10681 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010683res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10684shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10685 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
10686 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
10687 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
10688 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
10689 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
10690 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010692res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10693shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10694 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
10695 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10696 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10697 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10698 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
10699 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010701res.ver : string
10702resp_ver : string (deprecated)
10703 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
10704 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010706 ACL derivatives :
10707 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010709set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10710 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10711 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
10712 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
10713 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010715 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
10716 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010718 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010720status : integer
10721 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
10722 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
10723 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010725url : string
10726 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
10727 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
10728 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
10729 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
10730 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
10731 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
10732 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010734 ACL derivatives :
10735 url : exact string match
10736 url_beg : prefix match
10737 url_dir : subdir match
10738 url_dom : domain match
10739 url_end : suffix match
10740 url_len : length match
10741 url_reg : regex match
10742 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010744url_ip : ip
10745 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
10746 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
10747 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
10748 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
10749 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
10750 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10751 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010753url_port : integer
10754 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
10755 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
10756 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10757 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010759urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10760url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10761 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
10762 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
10763 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
10764 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
10765 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
10766 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
10767 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
10768 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
10769 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010771 ACL derivatives :
10772 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
10773 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
10774 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
10775 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
10776 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
10777 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
10778 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
10779 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010780
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010782 Example :
10783 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
10784 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
10785 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
10786 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010788urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
10789 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
10790 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
10791 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020010792
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010010793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200107947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010795---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010797Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
10798every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010799order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010800
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010801ACL name Equivalent to Usage
10802---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010803FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020010804HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010805HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
10806HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010807HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
10808HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
10809HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
10810HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
10811LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010812METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
10813METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
10814METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
10815METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
10816METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
10817METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010818RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010819REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010820TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010821WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
10822---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010823
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010824
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108258. Logging
10826----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010827
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010828One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
10829provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
10830very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
10831provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
10832state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010833to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010834headers.
10835
10836In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
10837about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
10838send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
10839
10840 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
10841 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
10842 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
10843 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
10844 at the termination.
10845
10846The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
10847allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
10848as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
10849while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
10850real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
10851delay.
10852
10853
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108548.1. Log levels
10855---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010856
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010857TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010858source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010859HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
10860in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
10861track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
10862syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
10863about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010864
10865
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108668.2. Log formats
10867----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010868
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010869HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010870and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
10871slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
10872options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010873
10874 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
10875 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
10876 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
10877 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
10878 extents.
10879
10880 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
10881 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
10882 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
10883 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
10884 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
10885
10886 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
10887 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
10888 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
10889 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
10890 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
10891
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010892 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
10893 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
10894 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
10895 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
10896
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010897 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
10898
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010899Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
10900specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
10901field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
10902servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
10903always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
10904identifier.
10905
10906Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
10907 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
10908 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
10909 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
10910 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
10911
10912
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109138.2.1. Default log format
10914-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010915
10916This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
10917as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
10918format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
10919
10920 Example :
10921 listen www
10922 mode http
10923 log global
10924 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10925
10926 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
10927 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
10928 (www/HTTP)
10929
10930 Field Format Extract from the example above
10931 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
10932 2 'Connect from' Connect from
10933 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
10934 4 'to' to
10935 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
10936 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
10937
10938Detailed fields description :
10939 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
10940 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
10941 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
10942 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
10943 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10944 and processed the connection.
10945 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
10946
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010947In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
10948"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
10949connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
10950
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010951It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
10952will eventually disappear.
10953
10954
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109558.2.2. TCP log format
10956---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010957
10958The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
10959is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
10960information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
10961counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
10962emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
10963environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
10964the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
10965sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010966specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
10967not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
10968fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
10969marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010970
10971 Example :
10972 frontend fnt
10973 mode tcp
10974 option tcplog
10975 log global
10976 default_backend bck
10977
10978 backend bck
10979 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10980
10981 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
10982 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
10983 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
10984
10985 Field Format Extract from the example above
10986 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
10987 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
10988 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
10989 4 frontend_name fnt
10990 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
10991 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
10992 7 bytes_read* 212
10993 8 termination_state --
10994 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
10995 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
10996
10997Detailed fields description :
10998 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010999 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11000 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11001 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11002 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11003 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011004
11005 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011006 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11007 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11008 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011009
11010 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11011 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11012 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11013 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11014
11015 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11016 and processed the connection.
11017
11018 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11019 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11020 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11021 applications.
11022
11023 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11024 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11025 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11026 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11027 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11028
11029 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11030 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11031 See "Timers" below for more details.
11032
11033 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11034 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11035 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11036 "Timers" below for more details.
11037
11038 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
11039 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
11040 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11041 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11042 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11043 details.
11044
11045 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11046 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11047 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11048 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11049 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11050
11051 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11052 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11053 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11054 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11055 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11056 for more details.
11057
11058 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011059 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011060 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11061 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11062 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011063 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011064
11065 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11066 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11067 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11068 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11069 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11070 caused by a denial of service attack.
11071
11072 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11073 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11074 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11075 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11076 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11077 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11078 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11079 denial of service attack.
11080
11081 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11082 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11083 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11084 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11085 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11086 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11087 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11088 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11089 be processed than on other servers.
11090
11091 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11092 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11093 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11094 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11095 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11096 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11097 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11098 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11099 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11100 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11101 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11102 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11103 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11104
11105 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11106 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11107 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11108 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11109 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11110 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11111 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11112 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11113
11114 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11115 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11116 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11117 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11118 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11119 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11120 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11121 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11122 occurs.
11123
11124
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111258.2.3. HTTP log format
11126----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011127
11128The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11129is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11130the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11131are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11132emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11133generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11134"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11135which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011136frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11137is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011138
11139Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11140slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11141with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11142
11143 Example :
11144 frontend http-in
11145 mode http
11146 option httplog
11147 log global
11148 default_backend bck
11149
11150 backend static
11151 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11152
11153 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11154 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11155 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011156 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011157
11158 Field Format Extract from the example above
11159 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11160 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11161 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11162 4 frontend_name http-in
11163 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11164 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
11165 7 status_code 200
11166 8 bytes_read* 2750
11167 9 captured_request_cookie -
11168 10 captured_response_cookie -
11169 11 termination_state ----
11170 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
11171 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11172 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
11173 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
11174 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011175
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011176
11177Detailed fields description :
11178 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011179 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11180 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11181 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11182 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11183 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011184
11185 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011186 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11187 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11188 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011189
11190 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
11191 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
11192 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
11193 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
11194 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
11195
11196 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11197 and processed the connection.
11198
11199 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11200 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11201 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
11202
11203 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11204 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11205 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11206 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
11207 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
11208 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
11209
11210 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
11211 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
11212 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
11213 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
11214 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
11215 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
11216
11217 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11218 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11219 See "Timers" below for more details.
11220
11221 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11222 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11223 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
11224 below for more details.
11225
11226 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
11227 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
11228 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
11229 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
11230 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
11231 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
11232 for more details.
11233
11234 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
11235 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
11236 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11237 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11238 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11239 details.
11240
11241 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
11242 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
11243 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
11244
11245 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
11246 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
11247 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
11248 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
11249 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
11250 overflowing.
11251
11252 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
11253 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
11254 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
11255 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
11256 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
11257 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
11258 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
11259 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11260
11261 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
11262 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
11263 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
11264 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
11265 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
11266 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
11267 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
11268 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11269
11270 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11271 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11272 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
11273 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
11274 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
11275 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
11276 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
11277
11278 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011279 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011280 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
11281 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
11282 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011283 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011284 system.
11285
11286 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11287 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11288 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11289 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11290 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11291 caused by a denial of service attack.
11292
11293 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11294 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11295 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11296 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11297 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11298 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11299 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11300 denial of service attack.
11301
11302 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11303 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11304 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11305 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11306 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11307 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11308 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11309 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
11310 processed than on other servers.
11311
11312 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11313 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11314 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11315 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11316 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11317 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11318 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11319 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11320 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11321 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11322 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11323 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11324 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11325
11326 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11327 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11328 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11329 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11330 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11331 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11332 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11333 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11334
11335 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11336 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11337 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11338 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11339 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11340 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11341 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11342 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11343 occurs.
11344
11345 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
11346 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
11347 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
11348 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
11349 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
11350 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
11351 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
11352 cookies" below for more details.
11353
11354 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
11355 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
11356 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
11357 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
11358 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
11359 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
11360 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
11361 and cookies" below for more details.
11362
11363 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
11364 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
11365 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
11366 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
11367 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
11368 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
11369 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
11370 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
11371
11372
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200113738.2.4. Custom log format
11374------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011375
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011376The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011377mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011378
11379HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
11380Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
11381separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
11382prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
11383
11384Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
11385variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
11386string formats ("Q").
11387
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011388If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011389as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011390less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
11391the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
11392
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011393Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010011394In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceeded by another '%' resulting
11395in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011396
11397Flags are :
11398 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011399 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011400
11401 Example:
11402
11403 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
11404 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
11405
11406At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
11407
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011408 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
11409 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011410
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011411the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011412
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011413 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011414 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011415 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011416
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011417and the default TCP format is defined this way :
11418
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011419 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011420 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
11421
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011422Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
11423
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011424 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011425 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011426 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
11427 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
11428 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011429 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
11430 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
11431 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011432 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011433 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011434 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011435 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011436 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080011437 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011438 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
11439 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011440 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011441 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
11442 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011443 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011444 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
11445 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011446 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11447 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
11448 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011449 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011450 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
11451 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011452 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011453 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11454 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
11455 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011456 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011457 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
11458 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
11459 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
11460 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011461 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011462 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011463 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011464 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010011465 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011466 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011467 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
11468 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
11469 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011470 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011471 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
11472 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011473 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011474 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011475 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011476 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011477
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011478 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011479
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010011480
114818.2.5. Error log format
11482-----------------------
11483
11484When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
11485protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
11486By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
11487"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
11488will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
11489logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
11490
11491The format looks like this :
11492
11493 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
11494 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
11495 Connection error during SSL handshake
11496
11497 Field Format Extract from the example above
11498 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
11499 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
11500 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
11501 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
11502 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
11503
11504These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
11505failures.
11506
11507
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115088.3. Advanced logging options
11509-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011510
11511Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
11512just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
11513options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
11514for more information about their usage.
11515
11516
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115178.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
11518------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011519
11520It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
11521haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
11522commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
11523monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
11524ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
11525
11526 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
11527 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
11528 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
11529 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
11530
11531 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
11532 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
11533 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
11534 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
11535 such as other load-balancers.
11536
11537 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
11538 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
11539 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
11540
11541
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115428.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
11543----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011544
11545The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
11546what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
11547or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
11548"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
11549just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
11550log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
11551after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
11552is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
11553with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
11554with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
11555
11556
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115578.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
11558------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011559
11560Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
11561for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
11562"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
11563retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
11564raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
11565a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
11566file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
11567you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
11568"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
11569
11570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115718.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
11572--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011573
11574Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
11575multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
11576them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
11577"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
11578logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
11579error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
11580and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
11581too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
11582useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
11583alternative.
11584
11585
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115868.4. Timing events
11587------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011588
11589Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
11590reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
11591the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
11592frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
11593mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
11594
11595 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
11596 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
11597 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
11598 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
11599 the client closes prematurely or times out.
11600
11601 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
11602 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
11603 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
11604 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
11605 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
11606
11607 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
11608 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
11609 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
11610 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
11611 connection never established.
11612
11613 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
11614 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
11615 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
11616 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
11617 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
11618 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
11619 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
11620 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
11621 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
11622 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
11623 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
11624
11625 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
11626 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
11627 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
11628 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
11629 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
11630
11631 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
11632
11633 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
11634 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
11635 negative.
11636
11637These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
11638protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
11639that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011640due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011641close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
11642session has been aborted on timeout.
11643
11644Most common cases :
11645
11646 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11647 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
11648 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
11649 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
11650 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
11651 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
11652 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
11653 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
11654 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020011655 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
11656 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
11657 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011658
11659 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11660 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
11661 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
11662 of ms on remote networks.
11663
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011664 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
11665 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
11666 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011667
11668 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
11669 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
11670 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
11671 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
11672 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
11673 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
11674 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
11675 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
11676 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
11677 to the server until another one is released.
11678
11679Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
11680
11681 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
11682 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
11683 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
11684
11685 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
11686 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
11687 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
11688
11689 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
11690 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
11691 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
11692 flags.
11693
11694 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
11695 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
11696 Check the session termination flags, then check the
11697 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
11698 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
11699 the client connection was maintained open.
11700
11701 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
11702 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
11703 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
11704 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
11705
11706
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117078.5. Session state at disconnection
11708-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011709
11710TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
11711"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
117122-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
11713each of which has a special meaning :
11714
11715 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
11716 session to terminate :
11717
11718 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
11719
11720 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
11721 server explicitly refused it.
11722
11723 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
11724 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
11725 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
11726 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011727 (eg: cacheable cookie).
11728
11729 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
11730 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011731
11732 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
11733 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
11734 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
11735 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
11736 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
11737
11738 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
11739 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
11740 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
11741 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
11742 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
11743
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090011744 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
11745 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
11746
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011747 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
11748 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
11749 backup connections when going up.
11750
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020011751 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
11752
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011753 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
11754 send or receive data.
11755
11756 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
11757 send or receive data.
11758
11759 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
11760 with nothing left in the buffers.
11761
11762 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
11763
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010011764 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011765 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
11766
11767 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
11768 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
11769 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
11770 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
11771 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
11772
11773 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
11774 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
11775
11776 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
11777 server (HTTP only).
11778
11779 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
11780
11781 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
11782 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
11783 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
11784
11785 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
11786 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
11787 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
11788
11789 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
11790
11791 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
11792 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
11793
11794 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
11795 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
11796 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
11797
11798 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
11799 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020011800 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
11801 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011802
11803 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
11804 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
11805 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
11806 another server.
11807
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011808 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011809 server.
11810
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011811 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
11812 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
11813 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
11814 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11815
11816 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
11817 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
11818 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
11819 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11820
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020011821 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
11822 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
11823 "use-server" rule).
11824
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011825 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11826
11827 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
11828 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
11829
11830 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
11831
11832 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
11833 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
11834 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
11835
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011836 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
11837 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
11838 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
11839 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
11840 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
11841
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011842 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
11843
11844 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
11845 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
11846
11847 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
11848
11849 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11850
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011851The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
11852was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011853helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
11854starvation, attacks, etc...
11855
11856The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
11857alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
11858easier finding and understanding.
11859
11860 Flags Reason
11861
11862 -- Normal termination.
11863
11864 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
11865 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
11866 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
11867 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
11868
11869 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
11870 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
11871 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
11872 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
11873 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
11874 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011875
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011876 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11877 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011878 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011879
11880 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
11881 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
11882 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
11883
11884 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
11885 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
11886 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
11887 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
11888 the server takes too long to respond.
11889
11890 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
11891 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
11892 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
11893 long a time to respond.
11894
11895 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
11896 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
11897 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
11898 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
11899 and the client.
11900
11901 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
11902 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
11903 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
11904 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
11905 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
11906 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
11907
11908 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
11909 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011910 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
11911 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
11912 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
11913 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011914
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011915 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
11916 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
11917
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011918 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011919 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
11920 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
11921 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
11922 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
11923 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
11924
11925 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
11926 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
11927 503 or 504 here.
11928
11929 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
11930 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
11931 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
11932 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
11933 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
11934
11935 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11936 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011937 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011938 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
11939 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
11940
11941 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
11942 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
11943 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
11944 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
11945 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
11946 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
11947 between haproxy and the server.
11948
11949 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
11950 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
11951 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
11952 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
11953 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
11954 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
11955 solution is to fix the application.
11956
11957 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
11958 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
11959 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
11960 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
11961 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
11962 external attacks.
11963
11964 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
11965 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011966 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011967 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
11968 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
11969
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011970 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
11971 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
11972 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020011973 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
11974 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011975
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011976 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
11977 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
11978 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
11979 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011980 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
11981 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
11982 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
11983 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
11984 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011985
11986 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
11987 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
11988 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
11989 returned an HTTP 403 error.
11990
11991 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
11992 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
11993 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
11994 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
11995
11996 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
11997 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
11998 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
11999 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12000
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012001The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12002persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12003important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12004re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12005
12006 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12007
12008 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12009 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12010 set on a GET request.
12011
12012 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12013 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012014 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012015 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12016
12017 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12018 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12019 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12020
12021 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12022 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12023 already got a cookie.
12024
12025 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12026 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12027 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12028 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12029 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12030
12031 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12032 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12033 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12034
12035 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12036 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12037 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12038
12039 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12040 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12041
12042 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12043 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12044 then advertised in the response.
12045
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012046
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120478.6. Non-printable characters
12048-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012049
12050In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12051consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12052converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12053prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12054being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12055escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12056is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12057'}' when logging headers.
12058
12059Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12060issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12061containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12062
12063Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12064the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12065performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12066
12067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120688.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12069---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012070
12071Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12072achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012073section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012074cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12075the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12076the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012077locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012078not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12079user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12080a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12081wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12082
12083 Examples :
12084 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12085 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12086
12087 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12088 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12089
12090
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120918.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12092---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012093
12094Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12095proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12096the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12097server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12098
12099Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12100response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012101section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012102
12103It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012104time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12105appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012106are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12107and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12108follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12109request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12110in the logs.
12111
12112 Example :
12113 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12114 listen proxy-out
12115 mode http
12116 option httplog
12117 option logasap
12118 log global
12119 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12120
12121 # log the name of the virtual server
12122 capture request header Host len 20
12123
12124 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12125 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12126
12127 # log the beginning of the referrer
12128 capture request header Referer len 20
12129
12130 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12131 capture response header Server len 20
12132
12133 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12134 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12135
12136 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12137 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12138
12139 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12140 capture response header Via len 20
12141
12142 # log the URL location during a redirection
12143 capture response header Location len 20
12144
12145 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12146 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12147 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12148 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
12149 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
12150
12151 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12152 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12153 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12154 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012155 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012156
12157 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12158 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12159 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12160 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
12161 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012162 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012163
12164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121658.9. Examples of logs
12166---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012167
12168These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
12169them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
12170reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
12171
12172 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
12173 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12174 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12175
12176 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
12177 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
12178
12179 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
12180 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
12181 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12182
12183 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
12184 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
12185
12186 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
12187 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12188 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
12189
12190 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012191 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012192 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
12193 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
12194
12195 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
12196 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
12197 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
12198
12199 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
12200 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020012201 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012202 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
12203 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
12204 to return the 502 and not the server.
12205
12206 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012207 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012208
12209 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
12210 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
12211 Nothing was sent to any server.
12212
12213 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
12214 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
12215
12216 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
12217 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
12218 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
12219 send a 408 return code to the client.
12220
12221 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
12222 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
12223
12224 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
12225 5 seconds ("c----").
12226
12227 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
12228 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012229 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012230
12231 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012232 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012233 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
12234 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
12235 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
12236 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
12237 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012238
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012239
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122409. Statistics and monitoring
12241----------------------------
12242
12243It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
12244mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
12245CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
12246Unix socket.
12247
12248
122499.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012250---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012251
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010012252The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
12253page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
12254
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012255 0. pxname: proxy name
12256 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
12257 for server)
12258 2. qcur: current queued requests
12259 3. qmax: max queued requests
12260 4. scur: current sessions
12261 5. smax: max sessions
12262 6. slim: sessions limit
12263 7. stot: total sessions
12264 8. bin: bytes in
12265 9. bout: bytes out
12266 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012267 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012268 12. ereq: request errors
12269 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012270 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012271 15. wretr: retries (warning)
12272 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010012273 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012274 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
12275 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
12276 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
12277 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
12278 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
12279 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
12280 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
12281 25. qlimit: queue limit
12282 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
12283 27. iid: unique proxy id
12284 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
12285 29. throttle: warm up status
12286 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
12287 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020012288 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020012289 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
12290 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
12291 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012292 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012293 UNK -> unknown
12294 INI -> initializing
12295 SOCKERR -> socket error
12296 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
12297 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
12298 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
12299 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
12300 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
12301 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12302 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12303 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
12304 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
12305 disable-on-404
12306 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12307 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12308 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012309 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
12310 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012311 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
12312 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
12313 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
12314 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
12315 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
12316 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012317 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
12318 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
12319 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
12320 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012321 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
12322 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010012323 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
12324 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
12325 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010012326 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012327
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012328
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123299.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012330-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012331
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012332The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
12333necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
12334A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
12335issuing commands by hand :
12336
12337 global
12338 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12339 stats timeout 2m
12340
12341It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
12342the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
12343never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
12344situations :
12345
12346 global
12347 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12348 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
12349 stats timeout 2m
12350
12351To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
12352swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
12353to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
12354syntaxes we'll use are the following :
12355
12356 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
12357 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
12358
12359The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
12360script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
12361for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
12362
12363The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
12364that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
12365editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
12366(eg: watch a counter).
12367
12368The socket supports two operation modes :
12369 - interactive
12370 - non-interactive
12371
12372The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
12373this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
12374sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
12375mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
12376commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
12377example :
12378
12379 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
12380
12381The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
12382entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
12383for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
12384sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
12385"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
12386after processing the last command of the same line.
12387
12388For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
12389"prompt" command :
12390
12391 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
12392 prompt
12393 > show info
12394 ...
12395 >
12396
12397Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
12398delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
12399that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
12400parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012401
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012402It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
12403on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
12404own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012405
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012406The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
12407If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
12408all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
12409it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
12410
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012411add map <map> <key> <value>
12412 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
12413 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
12414 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation.
12415
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012416clear counters
12417 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
12418 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
12419 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
12420 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
12421 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12422
12423clear counters all
12424 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
12425 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
12426 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
12427
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012428clear map <map>
12429 Remove all entries from the map <map>.
12430
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012431clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
12432 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
12433
12434 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
12435 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
12436 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
12437 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
12438 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
12439 later after the session ends is usual enough.
12440
12441 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
12442
12443 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
12444 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
12445 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
12446 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
12447 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
12448 the ACLs :
12449
12450 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12451 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12452 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12453 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12454 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12455 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12456
12457 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012458 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
12459 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012460
12461 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012462 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012463 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012464 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12465 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12466 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12467 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012468
12469 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12470
12471 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012472 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012473 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12474 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012475 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12476 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12477 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012478
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012479enable agent <backend>/<server>
12480 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
12481
12482 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
12483 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
12484 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
12485 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
12486 re-enabled using enable agent.
12487
12488 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
12489 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
12490 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
12491 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
12492 otherwise unchanged.
12493
12494 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
12495 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
12496 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
12497
12498 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12499 level "admin".
12500
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012501del map <map> <key>
12502 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
12503
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012504disable frontend <frontend>
12505 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
12506 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
12507 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
12508 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
12509 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
12510 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
12511 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
12512 on the stats page.
12513
12514 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12515 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12516
12517 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12518 level "admin".
12519
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012520disable server <backend>/<server>
12521 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
12522 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
12523 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
12524 during the maintenance.
12525
12526 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
12527 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
12528
12529 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012530 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012531
12532 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12533 level "admin".
12534
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012535enable agent <backend>/<server>
12536 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
12537
12538 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
12539 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
12540
12541 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12542 level "admin".
12543
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012544enable frontend <frontend>
12545 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
12546 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
12547 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
12548 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
12549 which was disabled.
12550
12551 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12552 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12553
12554 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12555 level "admin".
12556
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012557enable server <backend>/<server>
12558 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
12559 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
12560
12561 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012562 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012563
12564 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12565 level "admin".
12566
12567get weight <backend>/<server>
12568 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
12569 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
12570 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
12571 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
12572 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012573 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012574
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012575help
12576 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
12577 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012578
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012579prompt
12580 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
12581 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
12582 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
12583 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
12584 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
12585 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
12586 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
12587 command.
12588
12589quit
12590 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012591
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012592set map <map> <key> <value>
12593 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. The new value
12594 is <value>.
12595
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012596set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020012597 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
12598 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
12599 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
12600 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
12601 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012602 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
12603 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12604
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020012605set maxconn global <maxconn>
12606 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
12607 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
12608 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
12609 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
12610 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
12611 setting.
12612
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020012613set rate-limit connections global <value>
12614 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
12615 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12616 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12617 is passed in number of connections per second.
12618
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012619set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
12620 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
12621 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010012622 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
12623 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012624
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020012625set rate-limit sessions global <value>
12626 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
12627 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12628 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12629 is passed in number of sessions per second.
12630
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020012631set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
12632 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
12633 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12634 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12635 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
12636 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
12637
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012638set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012639 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
12640 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
12641 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
12642 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012643 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
12644 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012645
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012646set timeout cli <delay>
12647 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
12648 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
12649 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
12650
12651set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
12652 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
12653 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090012654 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
12655 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
12656 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
12657 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
12658 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
12659 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
12660 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
12661 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
12662 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
12663 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
12664 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
12665 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
12666 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012667
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012668show errors [<iid>]
12669 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
12670 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012671 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
12672 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
12673 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012674
12675 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
12676 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
12677 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
12678 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
12679 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
12680 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
12681 are reported too.
12682
12683 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
12684 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
12685 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
12686 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
12687 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
12688 code.
12689
12690 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
12691 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
12692 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
12693 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
12694 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
12695 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
12696 line.
12697
12698 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012699 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12700 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012701 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
12702 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
12703
12704 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
12705 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
12706 00038 Location: blah\r\n
12707 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
12708 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
12709 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
12710 00204+ minal\r\n
12711 00211 \r\n
12712
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012713 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012714 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
12715 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
12716 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
12717 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
12718 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
12719 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012720
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012721show info
12722 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
12723
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012724show map [<map>]
12725 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
12726 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped.
12727
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012728show sess
12729 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012730 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
12731 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12732
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010012733show sess <id>
12734 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
12735 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12736 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
12737 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
12738 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010012739 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
12740 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
12741 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012742
12743show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
12744 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
12745 possible to dump only selected items :
12746 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
12747 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
12748 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
12749 for example:
12750 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
12751 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
12752 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
12753
12754 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012755 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
12756 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012757 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
12758 Release_date: 2009/09/23
12759 Nbproc: 1
12760 Process_num: 1
12761 (...)
12762
12763 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
12764 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
12765 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
12766 (...)
12767 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
12768
12769 $
12770
12771 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
12772 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
12773 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
12774 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012775 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012776
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012777show table
12778 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
12779 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
12780 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
12781 entries currently in use.
12782
12783 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012784 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012785 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
12786 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012787
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012788show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012789 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
12790 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
12791 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012792 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
12793
12794 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
12795 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
12796 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
12797 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
12798 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
12799
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012800 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12801 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12802 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12803 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12804 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12805 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12806
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012807
12808 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012809 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
12810 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012811
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012812 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012813 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012814 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012815 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12816 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12817 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12818 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012819
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012820 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012821 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012822 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12823 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012824
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012825 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
12826 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012827 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012828 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12829 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012830
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012831 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
12832 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012833 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012834 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12835 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
12836
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012837 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
12838 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
12839 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
12840 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
12841 time goes, the average event rate drops.
12842
12843 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
12844 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
12845 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012846 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
12847 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012848 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
12849 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020012850
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012851shutdown frontend <frontend>
12852 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
12853 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
12854 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
12855 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
12856 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
12857 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
12858 once it is terminated.
12859
12860 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12861 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12862
12863 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12864 level "admin".
12865
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020012866shutdown session <id>
12867 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
12868 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12869 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
12870 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
12871 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
12872 flag in the logs.
12873
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020012874shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
12875 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
12876 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
12877 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
12878 'K' flag in the logs.
12879
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012880/*
12881 * Local variables:
12882 * fill-column: 79
12883 * End:
12884 */